]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - src/xterm.c
(handle_one_xevent): Don't pass buttons higher than 3
[gnu-emacs] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
3 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008
4 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5
6 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7
8 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
9 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
10 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
11 any later version.
12
13 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
16 GNU General Public License for more details.
17
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
20 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
21 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
22
23 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
24 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
25
26 #include <config.h>
27
28 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
29 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
30 #include <signal.h>
31
32 #include <stdio.h>
33
34 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
35
36 #include "lisp.h"
37 #include "blockinput.h"
38
39 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
40 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
41 #include "syssignal.h"
42
43 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
44 if this is not done before the other system files. */
45 #include "xterm.h"
46 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
47
48 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
49 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
50 #ifndef makedev
51 #include <sys/types.h>
52 #endif /* makedev */
53
54 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
55 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
56 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
57
58 #include "systime.h"
59
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
69
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "character.h"
72 #include "coding.h"
73 #include "ccl.h"
74 #include "frame.h"
75 #include "dispextern.h"
76 #include "fontset.h"
77 #include "termhooks.h"
78 #include "termopts.h"
79 #include "termchar.h"
80 #include "emacs-icon.h"
81 #include "disptab.h"
82 #include "buffer.h"
83 #include "window.h"
84 #include "keyboard.h"
85 #include "intervals.h"
86 #include "process.h"
87 #include "atimer.h"
88 #include "keymap.h"
89
90 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
91 #include <X11/Shell.h>
92 #endif
93
94 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
95 #include <sys/time.h>
96 #endif
97 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
98 #include <unistd.h>
99 #endif
100
101 #ifdef USE_GTK
102 #include "gtkutil.h"
103 #endif
104
105 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
106 #include "font.h"
107 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
108
109 #ifdef USE_LUCID
110 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
111 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
112 #endif
113
114 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
115
116 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
117 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
118 int));
119 #endif
120
121 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
122 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
123 #define HACK_EDITRES
124 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
125 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
126
127 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
128
129 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
130 #if defined USE_MOTIF
131 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
132 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
133 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
134
135 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
136 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
137 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
138 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
139 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
140 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
141 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
142 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
143 #ifndef XtNpickTop
144 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
145 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
146 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
147 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
148
149 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
150
151 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
152 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
153 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
154 #endif
155
156 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
157 #include "widget.h"
158 #ifndef XtNinitialState
159 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
160 #endif
161 #endif
162
163 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
164 #ifdef USE_XIM
165 int use_xim = 1;
166 #else
167 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
168 #endif
169
170 \f
171
172 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
173
174 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
175
176 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
177 start. */
178
179 static int any_help_event_p;
180
181 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
182 static Lisp_Object last_window;
183
184 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
185
186 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
187
188 /* Non-zero means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line. */
189
190 int x_underline_at_descent_line;
191
192 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
193 use. */
194
195 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
196
197 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
198 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
199 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
200 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
201
202 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
203
204 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
205 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
206 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
207 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
208
209 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
210
211 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
212
213 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
214
215 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
216 /* The application context for Xt use. */
217 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
218 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
219 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
220
221 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
222
223 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
224
225 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
226 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
227
228 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position;
229
230 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
231 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
232 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
233
234 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
235
236 /* Mouse movement.
237
238 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
239 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
240 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
241 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
242
243 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
244
245 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
246 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
247 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
248 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
249 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
250 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
251 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
252 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
253 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
254 is off. */
255
256 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
257
258 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
259 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
260 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
261
262 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
263
264 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
265 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
266 an ordinary motion.
267
268 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
269 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
270 event. */
271
272 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
273
274 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
275 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
276 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
277 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
278 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
279 it's somewhat accurate. */
280
281 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
282
283 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
284
285 static Time last_user_time;
286
287 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
288 events. */
289
290 #ifdef __STDC__
291 static int volatile input_signal_count;
292 #else
293 static int input_signal_count;
294 #endif
295
296 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
297
298 static int x_noop_count;
299
300 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
301
302 extern char **initial_argv;
303 extern int initial_argc;
304
305 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
306
307 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
308
309 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
310
311 extern Lisp_Object Qeql;
312
313 extern int errno;
314
315 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
316
317 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
318
319 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
320
321 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
322 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
323 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
324
325 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
326 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
327
328 /* Used in x_flush. */
329
330 extern Lisp_Object Vinhibit_redisplay;
331
332 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
333 extern int x_bitmap_mask P_ ((FRAME_PTR, int));
334
335 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
336 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
337 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
338 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
339
340 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
341 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
342 void x_delete_terminal P_ ((struct terminal *));
343 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
344 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
345 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
346 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
347 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((struct terminal *));
348 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((struct terminal *));
349 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
350 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
351 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
352 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
353 static void x_focus_changed P_ ((int, int, struct x_display_info *,
354 struct frame *, struct input_event *));
355 static void x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
356 XEvent *, struct input_event *));
357 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
358 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
359 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
360 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
361 enum text_cursor_kinds));
362
363 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC));
364 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
365 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
366 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
367 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
368 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Display *, Window));
369 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
370 enum scroll_bar_part *,
371 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
372 unsigned long *));
373 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
374 static void x_check_expected_move P_ ((struct frame *, int, int));
375 static void x_sync_with_move P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
376 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
377 int *, struct input_event *));
378 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
379 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
380 static SIGTYPE x_connection_closed P_ ((Display *, char *));
381
382
383 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
384
385 static void
386 x_flush (f)
387 struct frame *f;
388 {
389 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
390 connection may be broken. */
391 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
392 return;
393
394 BLOCK_INPUT;
395 if (f == NULL)
396 {
397 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
398 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
399 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
400 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
401 }
402 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
403 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
404 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
405 }
406
407
408 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
409 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
410 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
411 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
412 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
413 performance. */
414
415 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
416
417 \f
418 /***********************************************************************
419 Debugging
420 ***********************************************************************/
421
422 #if 0
423
424 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
425 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
426
427 struct record
428 {
429 char *locus;
430 int type;
431 };
432
433 struct record event_record[100];
434
435 int event_record_index;
436
437 record_event (locus, type)
438 char *locus;
439 int type;
440 {
441 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
442 event_record_index = 0;
443
444 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
445 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
446 event_record_index++;
447 }
448
449 #endif /* 0 */
450
451
452 \f
453 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
454
455 struct x_display_info *
456 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
457 Display *dpy;
458 {
459 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
460
461 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
462 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
463 return dpyinfo;
464
465 return 0;
466 }
467
468
469 \f
470 /***********************************************************************
471 Starting and ending an update
472 ***********************************************************************/
473
474 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
475 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
476 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
477 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
478 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
479
480 static void
481 x_update_begin (f)
482 struct frame *f;
483 {
484 /* Nothing to do. */
485 }
486
487
488 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
489 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
490 position of W. */
491
492 static void
493 x_update_window_begin (w)
494 struct window *w;
495 {
496 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
497 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
498
499 updated_window = w;
500 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
501
502 BLOCK_INPUT;
503
504 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
505 {
506 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
507 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
508
509 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
510 highlighting. */
511 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
512 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
513
514 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
515 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
516 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
517 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
518 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
519 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
520
521 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
522 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
523 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
524 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
525 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
526 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
527 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
528 {
529 int i;
530
531 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
532 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
533 break;
534
535 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
536 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
537 }
538 #endif /* 0 */
539 }
540
541 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
542 }
543
544
545 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
546
547 static void
548 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w, x, y0, y1)
549 struct window *w;
550 int x, y0, y1;
551 {
552 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
553 struct face *face;
554
555 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
556 if (face)
557 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
558 face->foreground);
559
560 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
561 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
562 }
563
564 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
565
566 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
567 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
568
569 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
570 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
571 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
572
573 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
574 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
575 here. */
576
577 static void
578 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
579 struct window *w;
580 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
581 {
582 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
583
584 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
585 {
586 BLOCK_INPUT;
587
588 if (cursor_on_p)
589 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
590 output_cursor.vpos,
591 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
592
593 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
594 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
595
596 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
597 }
598
599 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
600 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
601 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
602 {
603 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
604 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
605 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
606 }
607
608 updated_window = NULL;
609 }
610
611
612 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
613 update_end. */
614
615 static void
616 x_update_end (f)
617 struct frame *f;
618 {
619 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
620 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
621
622 #ifndef XFlush
623 BLOCK_INPUT;
624 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
625 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
626 #endif
627 }
628
629
630 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
631 complete update has been performed. The global variable
632 updated_window is not available here. */
633
634 static void
635 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
636 struct frame *f;
637 {
638 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
639 {
640 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
641
642 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
643 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
644 {
645 BLOCK_INPUT;
646 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
647 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
648 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
649 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
650 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
651 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
652 }
653 }
654 }
655
656
657 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
658 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
659 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
660 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
661 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
662 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
663
664 static void
665 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
666 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
667 {
668 struct window *w = updated_window;
669 struct frame *f;
670 int width, height;
671
672 xassert (w);
673
674 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
675 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
676
677 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
678 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
679 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
680 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
681 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
682 overhead is very small. */
683 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
684 && desired_row->full_width_p
685 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
686 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
687 width != 0)
688 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
689 height > 0))
690 {
691 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
692
693 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
694 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
695 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
696 y -= width;
697
698 BLOCK_INPUT;
699 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
700 0, y, width, height, False);
701 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
702 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
703 y, width, height, False);
704 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
705 }
706 }
707
708 static void
709 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, p)
710 struct window *w;
711 struct glyph_row *row;
712 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p;
713 {
714 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
715 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
716 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
717 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
718 struct face *face = p->face;
719 int rowY;
720
721 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
722 rowY = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
723 if (p->y < rowY)
724 {
725 /* Adjust position of "bottom aligned" bitmap on partially
726 visible last row. */
727 int oldY = row->y;
728 int oldVH = row->visible_height;
729 row->visible_height = p->h;
730 row->y -= rowY - p->y;
731 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
732 row->y = oldY;
733 row->visible_height = oldVH;
734 }
735 else
736 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
737
738 if (!p->overlay_p)
739 {
740 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
741
742 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
743 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
744 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
745 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
746 if (face->stipple)
747 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
748 else
749 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
750
751 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
752 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
753 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
754 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
755 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
756 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
757 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
758 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
759 {
760 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
761
762 if (sb_width > 0)
763 {
764 int left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
765 int width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
766 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
767
768 if (bx < 0)
769 {
770 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
771 if (left + width == p->x)
772 bx = left + sb_width;
773 else if (p->x + p->wd == left)
774 bx = left;
775 if (bx >= 0)
776 {
777 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
778
779 nx = width - sb_width;
780 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
781 row->y));
782 ny = row->visible_height;
783 }
784 }
785 else
786 {
787 if (left + width == bx)
788 {
789 bx = left + sb_width;
790 nx += width - sb_width;
791 }
792 else if (bx + nx == left)
793 nx += width - sb_width;
794 }
795 }
796 }
797 #endif
798 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
799 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
800
801 if (!face->stipple)
802 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
803 }
804
805 if (p->which)
806 {
807 unsigned char *bits;
808 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
809 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
810 XGCValues gcv;
811
812 if (p->wd > 8)
813 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
814 else
815 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
816
817 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
818 by the server. */
819 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
820 (p->cursor_p
821 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
822 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
823 : face->foreground),
824 face->background, depth);
825
826 if (p->overlay_p)
827 {
828 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
829 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
830 bits, p->wd, p->h,
831 1, 0, 1);
832 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
833 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
834 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
835 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
836 }
837
838 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
839 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
840 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
841
842 if (p->overlay_p)
843 {
844 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
845 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
846 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
847 }
848 }
849
850 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
851 }
852
853 \f
854
855 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
856 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
857 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
858 rarely happens). */
859
860 static void
861 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
862 {
863 }
864
865 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
866 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
867
868 static void
869 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
870 {
871 }
872
873
874 \f
875 /***********************************************************************
876 Display Iterator
877 ***********************************************************************/
878
879 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
880
881 static int x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *,
882 struct charset *, int *));
883
884
885 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
886 is not contained in the font. */
887
888 static XCharStruct *
889 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b, font_type)
890 XFontStruct *font;
891 XChar2b *char2b;
892 int font_type; /* unused on X */
893 {
894 /* The result metric information. */
895 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
896
897 xassert (font && char2b);
898
899 if (font->per_char != NULL)
900 {
901 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
902 {
903 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
904 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
905 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
906 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
907 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
908 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
909 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
910 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
911 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
912 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
913 }
914 else
915 {
916 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
917 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
918 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
919 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
920
921 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
922 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
923
924 where:
925
926 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
927 / = integer division
928 \ = integer modulus */
929 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
930 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
931 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
932 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
933 {
934 pcm = (font->per_char
935 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
936 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
937 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
938 }
939 }
940 }
941 else
942 {
943 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
944 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
945 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
946 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
947 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
948 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
949 }
950
951 return ((pcm == NULL
952 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
953 ? NULL : pcm);
954 }
955
956
957 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
958 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
959
960 static int
961 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info, charset, two_byte_p)
962 int c;
963 XChar2b *char2b;
964 struct font_info *font_info;
965 struct charset *charset;
966 int *two_byte_p;
967 {
968 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
969
970 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
971 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
972 fixed encoding. */
973 if (font_info->font_encoder)
974 {
975 /* It's a program. */
976 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
977
978 check_ccl_update (ccl);
979 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
980 {
981 ccl->reg[0] = CHARSET_ID (charset);
982 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
983 ccl->reg[2] = -1;
984 }
985 else
986 {
987 ccl->reg[0] = CHARSET_ID (charset);
988 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
989 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
990 }
991
992 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, Qnil);
993
994 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
995 program. */
996 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
997 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, 0, ccl->reg[1]);
998 else
999 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, ccl->reg[1], ccl->reg[2]);
1000 }
1001 else if (font_info->encoding_type)
1002 {
1003 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
1004 encoding numbers. */
1005 unsigned char enc = font_info->encoding_type;
1006
1007 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
1008 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
1009 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
1010
1011 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
1012 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
1013 }
1014
1015 if (two_byte_p)
1016 *two_byte_p = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
1017
1018 return FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
1019 }
1020
1021
1022 \f
1023 /***********************************************************************
1024 Glyph display
1025 ***********************************************************************/
1026
1027
1028
1029 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1030 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1031 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
1032 int));
1033 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1034 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1035 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1036 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1037 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1038 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1039 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1040 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1041 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
1042 unsigned long *, double, int));
1043 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
1044 double, int, unsigned long));
1045 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1046 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1047 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1048 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1049 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
1050 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
1051 int, int, int));
1052 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
1053 int, int, int, int, int, int,
1054 XRectangle *));
1055 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
1056 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
1057
1058 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
1059 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
1060 #endif
1061
1062
1063 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
1064 face. */
1065
1066 static void
1067 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
1068 struct glyph_string *s;
1069 {
1070 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
1071 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1072 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1073 && !s->cmp)
1074 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
1075 else
1076 {
1077 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
1078 XGCValues xgcv;
1079 unsigned long mask;
1080
1081 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
1082 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1083
1084 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
1085 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1086 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1087 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1088 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
1089 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1090 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1091
1092 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
1093 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
1094 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
1095 {
1096 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
1097 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1098 }
1099
1100 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1101 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
1102 if (enable_font_backend)
1103 xgcv.font = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->font->fid;
1104 else
1105 #endif
1106 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1107 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1108 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1109
1110 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1111 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1112 mask, &xgcv);
1113 else
1114 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1115 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1116
1117 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1118 }
1119 }
1120
1121
1122 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
1123
1124 static void
1125 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
1126 struct glyph_string *s;
1127 {
1128 int face_id;
1129 struct face *face;
1130
1131 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1132 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1133 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1134 if (face == NULL)
1135 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1136
1137 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1138 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
1139 else
1140 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
1141 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1142 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1143
1144 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
1145 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1146 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1147 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
1148 else if (enable_font_backend)
1149 /* No need of setting a font for s->gc. */
1150 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1151 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
1152 else
1153 {
1154 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1155 but font FONT. */
1156 XGCValues xgcv;
1157 unsigned long mask;
1158
1159 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1160 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1161 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1162 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
1163 if (enable_font_backend)
1164 xgcv.font = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->font->fid;
1165 else
1166 #endif
1167 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1168 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1169 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1170
1171 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1172 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1173 mask, &xgcv);
1174 else
1175 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1176 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1177
1178 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1179 }
1180
1181 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1182 }
1183
1184
1185 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1186 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1187 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1188
1189 static INLINE void
1190 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
1191 struct glyph_string *s;
1192 {
1193 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1194 }
1195
1196
1197 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1198 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1199 pattern. */
1200
1201 static INLINE void
1202 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
1203 struct glyph_string *s;
1204 {
1205 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1206
1207 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1208 {
1209 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1210 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1211 }
1212 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1213 {
1214 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1215 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1216 }
1217 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1218 {
1219 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1220 s->stippled_p = 0;
1221 }
1222 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1223 {
1224 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1225 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1226 }
1227 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1228 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1229 {
1230 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1231 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1232 }
1233 else
1234 {
1235 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1236 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1237 }
1238
1239 /* GC must have been set. */
1240 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1241 }
1242
1243
1244 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1245 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1246
1247 static INLINE void
1248 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
1249 struct glyph_string *s;
1250 {
1251 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
1252 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1253 #else
1254 XRectangle r[2];
1255 #endif
1256 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1257
1258 if (n > 0)
1259 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1260 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
1261 s->num_clips = n;
1262 #endif
1263 }
1264
1265
1266 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1267 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1268 the area of SRC. */
1269
1270 static void
1271 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (src, dst)
1272 struct glyph_string *src, *dst;
1273 {
1274 XRectangle r;
1275
1276 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
1277 if (enable_font_backend)
1278 {
1279 r.x = src->x;
1280 r.width = src->width;
1281 r.y = src->y;
1282 r.height = src->height;
1283 dst->clip[0] = r;
1284 dst->num_clips = 1;
1285 }
1286 else
1287 {
1288 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
1289 struct glyph_string *clip_head = src->clip_head;
1290 struct glyph_string *clip_tail = src->clip_tail;
1291
1292 /* This foces clipping just this glyph string. */
1293 src->clip_head = src->clip_tail = src;
1294 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (src, &r);
1295 src->clip_head = clip_head, src->clip_tail = clip_tail;
1296 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
1297 }
1298 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
1299 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1300 }
1301
1302
1303 /* RIF:
1304 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1305
1306 static void
1307 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
1308 struct glyph_string *s;
1309 {
1310 if (s->cmp == NULL
1311 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1312 {
1313 XCharStruct cs;
1314 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
1315
1316 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
1317 if (enable_font_backend)
1318 {
1319 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1320 struct font *font = (struct font *) s->font_info;
1321 struct font_metrics metrics;
1322 int i;
1323
1324 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1325 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1326 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1327 cs.rbearing = metrics.rbearing;
1328 cs.lbearing = metrics.lbearing;
1329 cs.width = metrics.width;
1330 }
1331 else
1332 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
1333 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
1334 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
1335 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
1336 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
1337 }
1338 else if (s->cmp)
1339 {
1340 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1341 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1342 }
1343 }
1344
1345
1346 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1347
1348 static INLINE void
1349 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
1350 struct glyph_string *s;
1351 int x, y, w, h;
1352 {
1353 XGCValues xgcv;
1354 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1355 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1356 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1357 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1358 }
1359
1360
1361 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1362 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1363 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1364 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1365 contains the first component of a composition. */
1366
1367 static void
1368 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
1369 struct glyph_string *s;
1370 int force_p;
1371 {
1372 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1373 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1374 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1375 {
1376 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1377
1378 if (s->stippled_p)
1379 {
1380 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1381 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1382 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1383 s->y + box_line_width,
1384 s->background_width,
1385 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1386 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1387 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1388 }
1389 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1390 || s->font_not_found_p
1391 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1392 || force_p)
1393 {
1394 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1395 s->background_width,
1396 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1397 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1398 }
1399 }
1400 }
1401
1402
1403 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1404
1405 static void
1406 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1407 struct glyph_string *s;
1408 {
1409 int i, x;
1410
1411 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1412 of S to the right of that box line. */
1413 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1414 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1415 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1416 else
1417 x = s->x;
1418
1419 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1420 loaded. */
1421 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1422 {
1423 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1424 {
1425 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1426 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1427 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1428 s->height - 1);
1429 x += g->pixel_width;
1430 }
1431 }
1432 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
1433 else if (enable_font_backend)
1434 {
1435 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
1436 struct font *font = (struct font *) s->font_info;
1437 int y;
1438
1439 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
1440 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
1441
1442 y = s->ybase - boff;
1443 if (s->for_overlaps
1444 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1445 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1446 else
1447 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1448 if (s->face->overstrike)
1449 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1450 }
1451 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
1452 else
1453 {
1454 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
1455 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
1456
1457 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
1458 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
1459
1460 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
1461 if (!s->two_byte_p)
1462 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1463 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
1464
1465 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
1466 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
1467 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
1468 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
1469 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
1470 if (s->for_overlaps
1471 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1472 {
1473 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
1474 if (s->two_byte_p)
1475 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1476 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1477 else
1478 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1479 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1480 }
1481 else
1482 {
1483 if (s->two_byte_p)
1484 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1485 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1486 else
1487 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1488 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1489 }
1490
1491 if (s->face->overstrike)
1492 {
1493 /* For overstriking (to simulate bold-face), draw the
1494 characters again shifted to the right by one pixel. */
1495 if (s->two_byte_p)
1496 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1497 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1498 else
1499 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1500 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1501 }
1502 }
1503 }
1504
1505 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1506
1507 static void
1508 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1509 struct glyph_string *s;
1510 {
1511 int i, j, x;
1512
1513 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1514 of S to the right of that box line. */
1515 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1516 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1517 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1518 else
1519 x = s->x;
1520
1521 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
1522 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1523 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1524 this composition. */
1525
1526 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1527 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1528 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1529 {
1530 if (s->gidx == 0)
1531 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1532 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1533 }
1534 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
1535 else if (enable_font_backend)
1536 {
1537 struct font *font = (struct font *) s->font_info;
1538 int y = s->ybase;
1539 int width = 0;
1540
1541 if (s->cmp->method == COMPOSITION_WITH_GLYPH_STRING)
1542 {
1543 Lisp_Object gstring = AREF (XHASH_TABLE (composition_hash_table)
1544 ->key_and_value,
1545 s->cmp->hash_index * 2);
1546 int from;
1547
1548 for (i = from = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1549 {
1550 Lisp_Object g = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1551 Lisp_Object adjustment = LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (g);
1552 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1553
1554 if (! VECTORP (adjustment))
1555 {
1556 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (g);
1557 continue;
1558 }
1559 if (from < i)
1560 {
1561 font->driver->draw (s, from, i, x, y, 0);
1562 x += width;
1563 }
1564 xoff = XINT (AREF (adjustment, 0));
1565 yoff = XINT (AREF (adjustment, 1));
1566 wadjust = XINT (AREF (adjustment, 2));
1567
1568 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1569 x += wadjust;
1570 from = i + 1;
1571 width = 0;
1572 }
1573 if (from < i)
1574 font->driver->draw (s, from, i, x, y, 0);
1575 }
1576 else
1577 {
1578 for (i = 0, j = s->gidx; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1579 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1580 {
1581 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1582 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1583
1584 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1585 if (s->face->overstrike)
1586 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1587 }
1588 }
1589 }
1590 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
1591 else
1592 {
1593 for (i = 0, j = s->gidx; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1594 if (s->face)
1595 {
1596 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1597 x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2],
1598 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1],
1599 s->char2b + j, 1);
1600 if (s->face->overstrike)
1601 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1602 x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2] + 1,
1603 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1],
1604 s->char2b + j, 1);
1605 }
1606 }
1607 }
1608
1609
1610 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1611
1612 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
1613 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1614 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
1615 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1616 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
1617
1618
1619 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1620 cannot be determined. */
1621
1622 static struct frame *
1623 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
1624 Widget widget;
1625 {
1626 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1627 Lisp_Object tail;
1628 struct frame *f;
1629
1630 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1631
1632 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1633 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1634 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1635 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1636 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1637 widget = XtParent (widget);
1638
1639 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1640 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1641 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1642 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1643 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1644 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1645 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1646 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1647 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1648 return f;
1649
1650 abort ();
1651 }
1652
1653
1654 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1655 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1656 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1657 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1658
1659 int
1660 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
1661 Widget widget;
1662 Colormap cmap;
1663 XColor *color;
1664 {
1665 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1666 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1667 }
1668
1669
1670 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1671 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1672 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1673 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1674 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1675 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1676
1677 int
1678 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1679 Widget widget;
1680 Display *display;
1681 Colormap cmap;
1682 unsigned long *pixel;
1683 double factor;
1684 int delta;
1685 {
1686 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1687 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1688 }
1689
1690
1691 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1692 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1693
1694 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1695 {
1696 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1697 sizeof (Screen *)},
1698 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1699 sizeof (Colormap)}
1700 };
1701
1702
1703 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1704 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1705
1706 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1707
1708
1709 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1710
1711 DPY is the display we are working on.
1712
1713 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1714 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1715 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1716 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1717
1718 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1719 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1720
1721 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1722 we allocated the color or not.
1723
1724 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1725
1726 static Boolean
1727 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
1728 Display *dpy;
1729 XrmValue *args;
1730 Cardinal *nargs;
1731 XrmValue *from, *to;
1732 XtPointer *closure_ret;
1733 {
1734 Screen *screen;
1735 Colormap cmap;
1736 Pixel pixel;
1737 String color_name;
1738 XColor color;
1739
1740 if (*nargs != 2)
1741 {
1742 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1743 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1744 "XtToolkitError",
1745 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1746 return False;
1747 }
1748
1749 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1750 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1751 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1752
1753 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1754 {
1755 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1756 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1757 }
1758 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1759 {
1760 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1761 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1762 }
1763 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1764 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1765 {
1766 pixel = color.pixel;
1767 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1768 }
1769 else
1770 {
1771 String params[1];
1772 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1773
1774 params[0] = color_name;
1775 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1776 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1777 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1778 params, &nparams);
1779 return False;
1780 }
1781
1782 if (to->addr != NULL)
1783 {
1784 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1785 {
1786 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1787 return False;
1788 }
1789
1790 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1791 }
1792 else
1793 {
1794 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1795 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1796 }
1797
1798 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1799 return True;
1800 }
1801
1802
1803 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1804 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1805 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1806
1807 APP is the application context in which we work.
1808
1809 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1810 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1811 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1812
1813 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1814
1815 static void
1816 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
1817 XtAppContext app;
1818 XrmValuePtr to;
1819 XtPointer closure;
1820 XrmValuePtr args;
1821 Cardinal *nargs;
1822 {
1823 if (*nargs != 2)
1824 {
1825 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1826 "XtToolkitError",
1827 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1828 NULL, NULL);
1829 }
1830 else if (closure != NULL)
1831 {
1832 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1833 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1834 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1835 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1836 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1837 }
1838 }
1839
1840
1841 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1842
1843
1844 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1845 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1846 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1847 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1848
1849 static const XColor *
1850 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
1851 Display *dpy;
1852 int *ncells;
1853 {
1854 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1855
1856 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1857 {
1858 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1859 int i;
1860
1861 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1862 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1863 dpyinfo->color_cells
1864 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1865 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1866
1867 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1868 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1869
1870 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1871 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1872 }
1873
1874 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1875 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1876 }
1877
1878
1879 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1880 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1881
1882 void
1883 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
1884 struct frame *f;
1885 XColor *colors;
1886 int ncolors;
1887 {
1888 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1889
1890 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1891 {
1892 int i;
1893 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1894 {
1895 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1896 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1897 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1898 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1899 }
1900 }
1901 else
1902 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1903 }
1904
1905
1906 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1907 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1908
1909 void
1910 x_query_color (f, color)
1911 struct frame *f;
1912 XColor *color;
1913 {
1914 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1915 }
1916
1917
1918 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1919 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1920 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1921 allocated. */
1922
1923 static int
1924 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
1925 Display *dpy;
1926 Colormap cmap;
1927 XColor *color;
1928 {
1929 int rc;
1930
1931 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1932 if (rc == 0)
1933 {
1934 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1935 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1936 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1937 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1938 int nearest, i;
1939 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1940 int ncells;
1941 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1942
1943 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1944 {
1945 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1946 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1947 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1948 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1949
1950 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1951 {
1952 nearest = i;
1953 nearest_delta = delta;
1954 }
1955 }
1956
1957 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1958 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1959 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1960 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1961 }
1962 else
1963 {
1964 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1965 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1966 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1967 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1968 XColor *cached_color;
1969
1970 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1971 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1972 (cached_color->red != color->red
1973 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1974 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1975 {
1976 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1977 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1978 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1979 }
1980 }
1981
1982 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1983 if (rc)
1984 register_color (color->pixel);
1985 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1986
1987 return rc;
1988 }
1989
1990
1991 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1992 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1993 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1994 allocated. */
1995
1996 int
1997 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
1998 struct frame *f;
1999 Colormap cmap;
2000 XColor *color;
2001 {
2002 gamma_correct (f, color);
2003 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
2004 }
2005
2006
2007 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
2008 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
2009 get color reference counts right. */
2010
2011 unsigned long
2012 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
2013 struct frame *f;
2014 unsigned long pixel;
2015 {
2016 XColor color;
2017
2018 color.pixel = pixel;
2019 BLOCK_INPUT;
2020 x_query_color (f, &color);
2021 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
2022 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2023 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
2024 register_color (pixel);
2025 #endif
2026 return color.pixel;
2027 }
2028
2029
2030 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
2031 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
2032 get color reference counts right. */
2033
2034 unsigned long
2035 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
2036 Display *dpy;
2037 Colormap cmap;
2038 unsigned long pixel;
2039 {
2040 XColor color;
2041
2042 color.pixel = pixel;
2043 BLOCK_INPUT;
2044 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
2045 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
2046 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2047 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
2048 register_color (pixel);
2049 #endif
2050 return color.pixel;
2051 }
2052
2053
2054 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
2055 boosted.
2056
2057 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
2058 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
2059 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
2060 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
2061 use an additional additive factor.
2062
2063 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
2064 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
2065 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
2066
2067
2068 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
2069 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
2070 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
2071 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
2072 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
2073 Value is non-zero if successful. */
2074
2075 static int
2076 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
2077 struct frame *f;
2078 Display *display;
2079 Colormap cmap;
2080 unsigned long *pixel;
2081 double factor;
2082 int delta;
2083 {
2084 XColor color, new;
2085 long bright;
2086 int success_p;
2087
2088 /* Get RGB color values. */
2089 color.pixel = *pixel;
2090 x_query_color (f, &color);
2091
2092 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
2093 xassert (factor >= 0);
2094 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
2095 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
2096 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
2097
2098 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
2099 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
2100
2101 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
2102 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
2103 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
2104 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
2105 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
2106 {
2107 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
2108 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
2109 /* The additive adjustment. */
2110 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
2111
2112 if (factor < 1)
2113 {
2114 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
2115 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
2116 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
2117 }
2118 else
2119 {
2120 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
2121 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
2122 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
2123 }
2124 }
2125
2126 /* Try to allocate the color. */
2127 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
2128 if (success_p)
2129 {
2130 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
2131 {
2132 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
2133 delta to the RGB values. */
2134 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
2135
2136 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
2137 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
2138 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
2139 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
2140 }
2141 else
2142 success_p = 1;
2143 *pixel = new.pixel;
2144 }
2145
2146 return success_p;
2147 }
2148
2149
2150 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
2151 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
2152 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
2153 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
2154 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
2155 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
2156
2157 static void
2158 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
2159 struct frame *f;
2160 struct relief *relief;
2161 double factor;
2162 int delta;
2163 unsigned long default_pixel;
2164 {
2165 XGCValues xgcv;
2166 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
2167 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
2168 unsigned long pixel;
2169 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
2170 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
2171 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
2172 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2173
2174 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
2175 xgcv.line_width = 1;
2176
2177 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
2178 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
2179 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
2180 if (relief->gc
2181 && relief->allocated_p)
2182 {
2183 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
2184 relief->allocated_p = 0;
2185 }
2186
2187 /* Allocate new color. */
2188 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
2189 pixel = background;
2190 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
2191 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
2192 {
2193 relief->allocated_p = 1;
2194 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
2195 }
2196
2197 if (relief->gc == 0)
2198 {
2199 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
2200 mask |= GCStipple;
2201 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
2202 }
2203 else
2204 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2205 }
2206
2207
2208 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
2209
2210 static void
2211 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
2212 struct glyph_string *s;
2213 {
2214 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
2215 unsigned long color;
2216
2217 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
2218 color = s->face->box_color;
2219 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
2220 && s->img->pixmap
2221 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
2222 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
2223 else
2224 {
2225 XGCValues xgcv;
2226
2227 /* Get the background color of the face. */
2228 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
2229 color = xgcv.background;
2230 }
2231
2232 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
2233 || color != di->relief_background)
2234 {
2235 di->relief_background = color;
2236 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
2237 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2238 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
2239 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2240 }
2241 }
2242
2243
2244 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2245 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2246 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2247 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2248 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2249 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2250 when drawing. */
2251
2252 static void
2253 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2254 raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2255 struct frame *f;
2256 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width;
2257 int top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
2258 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2259 {
2260 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2261 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2262 int i;
2263 GC gc;
2264
2265 if (raised_p)
2266 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2267 else
2268 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2269 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2270
2271 /* Top. */
2272 if (top_p)
2273 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2274 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2275 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2276 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2277
2278 /* Left. */
2279 if (left_p)
2280 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2281 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2282 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2283
2284 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2285 if (raised_p)
2286 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2287 else
2288 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2289 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2290
2291 /* Bottom. */
2292 if (bot_p)
2293 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2294 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2295 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2296 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2297
2298 /* Right. */
2299 if (right_p)
2300 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2301 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2302 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2303
2304 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2305 }
2306
2307
2308 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2309 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2310 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2311 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2312 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2313 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2314
2315 static void
2316 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2317 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2318 struct glyph_string *s;
2319 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
2320 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2321 {
2322 XGCValues xgcv;
2323
2324 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2325 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2326 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2327
2328 /* Top. */
2329 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2330 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2331
2332 /* Left. */
2333 if (left_p)
2334 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2335 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2336
2337 /* Bottom. */
2338 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2339 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2340
2341 /* Right. */
2342 if (right_p)
2343 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2344 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2345
2346 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2347 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2348 }
2349
2350
2351 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2352
2353 static void
2354 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
2355 struct glyph_string *s;
2356 {
2357 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2358 int left_p, right_p;
2359 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2360 XRectangle clip_rect;
2361
2362 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2363 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2364 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2365
2366 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2367 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2368 ? s->first_glyph
2369 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2370
2371 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2372 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2373 left_x = s->x;
2374 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2375 ? last_x - 1
2376 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2377 top_y = s->y;
2378 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2379
2380 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2381 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2382 && (s->prev == NULL
2383 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2384 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2385 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2386 && (s->next == NULL
2387 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2388
2389 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2390
2391 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2392 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2393 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2394 else
2395 {
2396 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2397 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2398 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2399 }
2400 }
2401
2402
2403 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2404
2405 static void
2406 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
2407 struct glyph_string *s;
2408 {
2409 int x = s->x;
2410 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2411
2412 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2413 right of that line. */
2414 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2415 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2416 && s->slice.x == 0)
2417 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2418
2419 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2420 by that margin. */
2421 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2422 x += s->img->hmargin;
2423 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2424 y += s->img->vmargin;
2425
2426 if (s->img->pixmap)
2427 {
2428 if (s->img->mask)
2429 {
2430 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2431 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2432 trust on the shape extension to be available
2433 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2434 manually. */
2435 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2436 | GCFunction);
2437 XGCValues xgcv;
2438 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2439
2440 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2441 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2442 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2443 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2444 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2445
2446 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2447 image_rect.x = x;
2448 image_rect.y = y;
2449 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2450 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2451 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2452 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2453 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2454 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2455 }
2456 else
2457 {
2458 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2459
2460 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2461 image_rect.x = x;
2462 image_rect.y = y;
2463 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2464 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2465 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2466 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2467 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2468 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2469
2470 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2471 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2472 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2473 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2474 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2475 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2476 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2477 {
2478 int r = s->img->relief;
2479 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2480 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2481 x - r, y - r,
2482 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2483 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2484 }
2485 }
2486 }
2487 else
2488 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2489 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2490 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2491 }
2492
2493
2494 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2495
2496 static void
2497 x_draw_image_relief (s)
2498 struct glyph_string *s;
2499 {
2500 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2501 XRectangle r;
2502 int x = s->x;
2503 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2504
2505 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2506 right of that line. */
2507 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2508 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2509 && s->slice.x == 0)
2510 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2511
2512 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2513 by that margin. */
2514 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2515 x += s->img->hmargin;
2516 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2517 y += s->img->vmargin;
2518
2519 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2520 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2521 {
2522 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2523 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2524 }
2525 else
2526 {
2527 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2528 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2529 }
2530
2531 x0 = x - thick;
2532 y0 = y - thick;
2533 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1;
2534 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1;
2535
2536 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2537 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2538 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2539 s->slice.y == 0,
2540 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2541 s->slice.x == 0,
2542 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2543 &r);
2544 }
2545
2546
2547 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2548
2549 static void
2550 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
2551 struct glyph_string *s;
2552 Pixmap pixmap;
2553 {
2554 int x = 0;
2555 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2556
2557 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2558 right of that line. */
2559 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2560 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2561 && s->slice.x == 0)
2562 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2563
2564 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2565 by that margin. */
2566 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2567 x += s->img->hmargin;
2568 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2569 y += s->img->vmargin;
2570
2571 if (s->img->pixmap)
2572 {
2573 if (s->img->mask)
2574 {
2575 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2576 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2577 trust on the shape extension to be available
2578 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2579 manually. */
2580 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2581 | GCFunction);
2582 XGCValues xgcv;
2583
2584 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2585 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2586 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2587 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2588 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2589
2590 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2591 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2592 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2593 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2594 }
2595 else
2596 {
2597 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2598 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2599 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2600
2601 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2602 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2603 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2604 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2605 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2606 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2607 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2608 {
2609 int r = s->img->relief;
2610 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2611 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2612 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2613 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2614 }
2615 }
2616 }
2617 else
2618 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2619 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2620 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2621 }
2622
2623
2624 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2625 give the rectangle to draw. */
2626
2627 static void
2628 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
2629 struct glyph_string *s;
2630 int x, y, w, h;
2631 {
2632 if (s->stippled_p)
2633 {
2634 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2635 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2636 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2637 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2638 }
2639 else
2640 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2641 }
2642
2643
2644 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2645
2646 s->y
2647 s->x +-------------------------
2648 | s->face->box
2649 |
2650 | +-------------------------
2651 | | s->img->margin
2652 | |
2653 | | +-------------------
2654 | | | the image
2655
2656 */
2657
2658 static void
2659 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
2660 struct glyph_string *s;
2661 {
2662 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2663 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2664 int height;
2665 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2666
2667 height = s->height;
2668 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2669 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2670 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2671 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2672
2673 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2674 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2675 flickering. */
2676 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2677 if (height > s->slice.height
2678 || s->img->hmargin
2679 || s->img->vmargin
2680 || s->img->mask
2681 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2682 || s->width != s->background_width)
2683 {
2684 if (s->img->mask)
2685 {
2686 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2687 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2688 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2689 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2690 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2691
2692 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2693 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2694 s->background_width,
2695 s->height, depth);
2696
2697 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2698 pixmap. */
2699 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2700
2701 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2702 if (s->stippled_p)
2703 {
2704 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2705 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2706 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2707 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2708 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2709 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2710 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2711 }
2712 else
2713 {
2714 XGCValues xgcv;
2715 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2716 &xgcv);
2717 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2718 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2719 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2720 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2721 }
2722 }
2723 else
2724 {
2725 int x = s->x;
2726 int y = s->y;
2727
2728 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2729 && s->slice.x == 0)
2730 x += box_line_hwidth;
2731
2732 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2733 y += box_line_vwidth;
2734
2735 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2736 }
2737
2738 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2739 }
2740
2741 /* Draw the foreground. */
2742 if (pixmap != None)
2743 {
2744 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2745 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2746 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2747 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2748 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2749 }
2750 else
2751 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2752
2753 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2754 if (s->img->relief
2755 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2756 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2757 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2758 }
2759
2760
2761 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2762
2763 static void
2764 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
2765 struct glyph_string *s;
2766 {
2767 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2768
2769 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2770 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2771 {
2772 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2773 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2774 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2775 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2776
2777 if (x < left_x)
2778 {
2779 background_width -= left_x - x;
2780 x = left_x;
2781 }
2782 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2783
2784 /* Draw cursor. */
2785 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2786
2787 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2788 if (width < background_width)
2789 {
2790 int y = s->y;
2791 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2792 XRectangle r;
2793 GC gc;
2794
2795 x += width;
2796 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2797 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2798 {
2799 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2800 gc = s->gc;
2801 }
2802 else
2803 gc = s->face->gc;
2804
2805 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2806 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2807
2808 if (s->face->stipple)
2809 {
2810 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2811 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2812 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2813 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2814 }
2815 else
2816 {
2817 XGCValues xgcv;
2818 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2819 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2820 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2821 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2822 }
2823 }
2824 }
2825 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2826 {
2827 int background_width = s->background_width;
2828 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2829
2830 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2831 except for header line and mode line. */
2832 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2833 {
2834 background_width -= left_x - x;
2835 x = left_x;
2836 }
2837 if (background_width > 0)
2838 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2839 }
2840
2841 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2842 }
2843
2844
2845 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2846
2847 static void
2848 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
2849 struct glyph_string *s;
2850 {
2851 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2852
2853 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2854 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2855 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2856 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2857 {
2858 int width;
2859 struct glyph_string *next;
2860
2861 for (width = 0, next = s->next; next;
2862 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2863 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2864 {
2865 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2866 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2867 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2868 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
2869 next->num_clips = 0;
2870 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
2871 }
2872 }
2873
2874 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2875 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2876
2877 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2878 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2879 if (!s->for_overlaps
2880 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2881 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2882 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2883
2884 {
2885 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2886 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2887 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2888 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2889 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2890 }
2891 else if ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2892 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang))
2893 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2894 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2895 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2896 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2897 else
2898 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2899
2900 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2901 {
2902 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2903 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2904 break;
2905
2906 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2907 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2908 break;
2909
2910 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2911 if (s->for_overlaps)
2912 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2913 else
2914 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2915 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2916 break;
2917
2918 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2919 if (s->for_overlaps || s->gidx > 0)
2920 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2921 else
2922 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2923 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2924 break;
2925
2926 default:
2927 abort ();
2928 }
2929
2930 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2931 {
2932 /* Draw underline. */
2933 if (s->face->underline_p)
2934 {
2935 unsigned long tem, h;
2936 int y;
2937
2938 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2939 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
2940 if (enable_font_backend)
2941 /* In the future, we must use information of font. */
2942 h = 1;
2943 else
2944 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
2945 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
2946 h = 1;
2947
2948 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
2949 if (enable_font_backend)
2950 {
2951 if (s->face->font)
2952 /* In the future, we must use information of font. */
2953 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
2954 else
2955 y = s->y + s->height - h;
2956 }
2957 else
2958 #endif
2959 {
2960 y = s->y + s->height - h;
2961 if (!x_underline_at_descent_line)
2962 {
2963 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2964 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2965 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2966 specs, and its default is
2967
2968 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2969 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2970
2971 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2972 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
2973 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
2974 else if (s->face->font)
2975 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
2976 }
2977 }
2978
2979 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2980 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2981 s->x, y, s->background_width, h);
2982 else
2983 {
2984 XGCValues xgcv;
2985 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2986 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2987 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2988 s->x, y, s->background_width, h);
2989 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2990 }
2991 }
2992
2993 /* Draw overline. */
2994 if (s->face->overline_p)
2995 {
2996 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2997
2998 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2999 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
3000 s->background_width, h);
3001 else
3002 {
3003 XGCValues xgcv;
3004 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
3005 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
3006 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
3007 s->background_width, h);
3008 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
3009 }
3010 }
3011
3012 /* Draw strike-through. */
3013 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
3014 {
3015 unsigned long h = 1;
3016 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
3017
3018 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
3019 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
3020 s->width, h);
3021 else
3022 {
3023 XGCValues xgcv;
3024 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
3025 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
3026 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
3027 s->width, h);
3028 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
3029 }
3030 }
3031
3032 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
3033 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
3034 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
3035
3036 if (s->prev)
3037 {
3038 struct glyph_string *prev;
3039
3040 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
3041 if (prev->hl != s->hl
3042 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
3043 {
3044 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
3045 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
3046 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
3047
3048 prev->hl = s->hl;
3049 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
3050 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
3051 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
3052 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
3053 else
3054 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
3055 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
3056 prev->hl = save;
3057 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
3058 prev->num_clips = 0;
3059 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
3060 }
3061 }
3062
3063 if (s->next)
3064 {
3065 struct glyph_string *next;
3066
3067 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
3068 if (next->hl != s->hl
3069 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
3070 {
3071 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
3072 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
3073 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
3074
3075 next->hl = s->hl;
3076 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
3077 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
3078 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
3079 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
3080 else
3081 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
3082 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
3083 next->hl = save;
3084 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
3085 next->num_clips = 0;
3086 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
3087 }
3088 }
3089 }
3090
3091 /* Reset clipping. */
3092 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
3093 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
3094 s->num_clips = 0;
3095 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
3096 }
3097
3098 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
3099
3100 void
3101 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, x, y, width, height, shift_by)
3102 struct frame *f;
3103 int x, y, width, height, shift_by;
3104 {
3105 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3106 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3107 x, y, width, height,
3108 x + shift_by, y);
3109 }
3110
3111 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
3112 for X frames. */
3113
3114 static void
3115 x_delete_glyphs (f, n)
3116 struct frame *f;
3117 register int n;
3118 {
3119 abort ();
3120 }
3121
3122
3123 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
3124 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
3125
3126 void
3127 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
3128 Display *dpy;
3129 Window window;
3130 int x, y;
3131 int width, height;
3132 int exposures;
3133 {
3134 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
3135 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
3136 }
3137
3138
3139 /* Clear an entire frame. */
3140
3141 static void
3142 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
3143 {
3144 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
3145 longer visible. */
3146 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
3147 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
3148 output_cursor.x = -1;
3149
3150 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
3151 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
3152 BLOCK_INPUT;
3153 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
3154
3155 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
3156 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
3157 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
3158
3159 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3160
3161 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3162 }
3163
3164
3165 \f
3166 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
3167
3168 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
3169 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
3170
3171 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3172
3173
3174 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
3175 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
3176
3177 static int
3178 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
3179 struct timeval *result, x, y;
3180 {
3181 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
3182 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
3183 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
3184 {
3185 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
3186 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
3187 y.tv_sec += nsec;
3188 }
3189
3190 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
3191 {
3192 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
3193 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
3194 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
3195 }
3196
3197 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
3198 positive. */
3199 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
3200 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
3201
3202 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
3203 negative. */
3204 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
3205 }
3206
3207 void
3208 XTflash (f)
3209 struct frame *f;
3210 {
3211 BLOCK_INPUT;
3212
3213 {
3214 GC gc;
3215
3216 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3217 pixels into background pixels. */
3218 {
3219 XGCValues values;
3220
3221 values.function = GXxor;
3222 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3223 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3224
3225 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3226 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3227 }
3228
3229 {
3230 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3231 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3232 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3233 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3234 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3235 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3236 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3237
3238 int width;
3239
3240 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3241 edge it is next to. */
3242 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3243 {
3244 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3245 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3246 break;
3247
3248 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3249 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3250 break;
3251
3252 default:
3253 break;
3254 }
3255
3256 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3257
3258 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3259 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3260 {
3261 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3262 flash_left,
3263 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3264 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
3265 width, flash_height);
3266 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3267 flash_left,
3268 (height - flash_height
3269 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3270 width, flash_height);
3271 }
3272 else
3273 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3274 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3275 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3276 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3277
3278 x_flush (f);
3279
3280 {
3281 struct timeval wakeup;
3282
3283 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
3284
3285 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
3286 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
3287 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
3288 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
3289
3290 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3291 available. */
3292 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3293 {
3294 struct timeval current;
3295 struct timeval timeout;
3296
3297 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
3298
3299 /* Break if result would be negative. */
3300 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
3301 break;
3302
3303 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3304 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
3305 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
3306
3307 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3308 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
3309 }
3310 }
3311
3312 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3313 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3314 {
3315 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3316 flash_left,
3317 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3318 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
3319 width, flash_height);
3320 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3321 flash_left,
3322 (height - flash_height
3323 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3324 width, flash_height);
3325 }
3326 else
3327 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3328 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3329 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3330 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3331
3332 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3333 x_flush (f);
3334 }
3335 }
3336
3337 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3338 }
3339
3340 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3341
3342
3343 /* Make audible bell. */
3344
3345 void
3346 XTring_bell ()
3347 {
3348 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3349
3350 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3351 {
3352 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3353 if (visible_bell)
3354 XTflash (f);
3355 else
3356 #endif
3357 {
3358 BLOCK_INPUT;
3359 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3360 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3361 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3362 }
3363 }
3364 }
3365
3366 \f
3367 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3368 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3369 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3370 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3371
3372 static void
3373 XTset_terminal_window (n)
3374 register int n;
3375 {
3376 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3377 }
3378
3379
3380 \f
3381 /***********************************************************************
3382 Line Dance
3383 ***********************************************************************/
3384
3385 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3386 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3387
3388 static void
3389 x_ins_del_lines (f, vpos, n)
3390 struct frame *f;
3391 int vpos, n;
3392 {
3393 abort ();
3394 }
3395
3396
3397 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3398
3399 static void
3400 x_scroll_run (w, run)
3401 struct window *w;
3402 struct run *run;
3403 {
3404 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3405 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3406
3407 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3408 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3409 fringe of W. */
3410 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3411
3412 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3413 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3414 bottom_y = y + height;
3415
3416 if (to_y < from_y)
3417 {
3418 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3419 line at the bottom. */
3420 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3421 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3422 else
3423 height = run->height;
3424 }
3425 else
3426 {
3427 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3428 at the bottom. */
3429 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3430 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3431 else
3432 height = run->height;
3433 }
3434
3435 BLOCK_INPUT;
3436
3437 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3438 updated_window = w;
3439 x_clear_cursor (w);
3440
3441 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3442 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3443 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3444 x, from_y,
3445 width, height,
3446 x, to_y);
3447
3448 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3449 }
3450
3451
3452 \f
3453 /***********************************************************************
3454 Exposure Events
3455 ***********************************************************************/
3456
3457 \f
3458 static void
3459 frame_highlight (f)
3460 struct frame *f;
3461 {
3462 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3463 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3464 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3465 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3466 BLOCK_INPUT;
3467 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3468 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3469 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3470 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3471 }
3472
3473 static void
3474 frame_unhighlight (f)
3475 struct frame *f;
3476 {
3477 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3478 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3479 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3480 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3481 BLOCK_INPUT;
3482 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3483 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3484 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3485 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3486 }
3487
3488 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3489 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3490 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3491 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3492 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3493
3494 static void
3495 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
3496 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3497 struct frame *frame;
3498 {
3499 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3500
3501 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3502 {
3503 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3504 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3505 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3506
3507 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3508 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3509
3510 #if 0
3511 selected_frame = frame;
3512 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
3513 selected_frame);
3514 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window, Qnil);
3515 choose_minibuf_frame ();
3516 #endif /* ! 0 */
3517
3518 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3519 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3520 else
3521 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3522 }
3523
3524 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3525 }
3526
3527 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3528 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3529 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3530
3531 static void
3532 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp)
3533 int type;
3534 int state;
3535 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3536 struct frame *frame;
3537 struct input_event *bufp;
3538 {
3539 if (type == FocusIn)
3540 {
3541 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3542 {
3543 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3544 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3545
3546 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3547 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3548 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3549 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3550 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3551 {
3552 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3553 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3554 }
3555 }
3556
3557 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3558
3559 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3560 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3561 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3562 #endif
3563 }
3564 else if (type == FocusOut)
3565 {
3566 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3567
3568 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3569 {
3570 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3571 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3572 }
3573
3574 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3575 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3576 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3577 #endif
3578 }
3579 }
3580
3581 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3582 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3583
3584 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3585
3586 static void
3587 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp)
3588 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3589 XEvent *event;
3590 struct input_event *bufp;
3591 {
3592 struct frame *frame;
3593
3594 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3595 if (! frame)
3596 return;
3597
3598 switch (event->type)
3599 {
3600 case EnterNotify:
3601 case LeaveNotify:
3602 {
3603 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3604 int focus_state
3605 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3606
3607 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3608 && event->xcrossing.focus
3609 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3610 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3611 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3612 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3613 }
3614 break;
3615
3616 case FocusIn:
3617 case FocusOut:
3618 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3619 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3620 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3621 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3622 break;
3623
3624 case ClientMessage:
3625 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3626 {
3627 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3628 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3629 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3630 }
3631 break;
3632 }
3633 }
3634
3635
3636 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3637
3638 void
3639 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
3640 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3641 {
3642 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3643 }
3644
3645 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3646 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3647 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3648
3649 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3650 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3651 the appropriate X display info. */
3652
3653 static void
3654 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
3655 struct frame *frame;
3656 {
3657 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3658 }
3659
3660 static void
3661 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
3662 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3663 {
3664 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3665
3666 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3667 {
3668 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3669 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3670 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3671 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3672 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3673 {
3674 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3675 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3676 }
3677 }
3678 else
3679 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3680
3681 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3682 {
3683 if (old_highlight)
3684 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3685 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3686 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3687 }
3688 }
3689
3690
3691 \f
3692 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3693
3694 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3695 static void
3696 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
3697 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3698 {
3699 int min_code, max_code;
3700 KeySym *syms;
3701 int syms_per_code;
3702 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3703
3704 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3705 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3706 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3707 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3708 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3709
3710 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3711
3712 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3713 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3714 &syms_per_code);
3715 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3716
3717 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3718 Alt keysyms are on. */
3719 {
3720 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3721 int found_alt_or_meta;
3722
3723 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3724 {
3725 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3726 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3727 {
3728 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3729
3730 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3731 if (code == 0)
3732 continue;
3733
3734 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3735 {
3736 int code_col;
3737
3738 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3739 {
3740 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3741
3742 switch (sym)
3743 {
3744 case XK_Meta_L:
3745 case XK_Meta_R:
3746 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3747 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3748 break;
3749
3750 case XK_Alt_L:
3751 case XK_Alt_R:
3752 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3753 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3754 break;
3755
3756 case XK_Hyper_L:
3757 case XK_Hyper_R:
3758 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3759 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3760 code_col = syms_per_code;
3761 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3762 break;
3763
3764 case XK_Super_L:
3765 case XK_Super_R:
3766 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3767 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3768 code_col = syms_per_code;
3769 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3770 break;
3771
3772 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3773 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3774 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3775 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3776 code_col = syms_per_code;
3777 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3778 break;
3779 }
3780 }
3781 }
3782 }
3783 }
3784 }
3785
3786 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3787 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3788 {
3789 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3790 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3791 }
3792
3793 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3794 make them just meta, not alt. */
3795 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3796 {
3797 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3798 }
3799
3800 XFree ((char *) syms);
3801 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3802 }
3803
3804 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3805 Emacs uses. */
3806
3807 unsigned int
3808 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3809 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3810 unsigned int state;
3811 {
3812 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3813 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3814 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3815 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3816 Lisp_Object tem;
3817
3818 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3819 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3820 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3821 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3822 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3823 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3824 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3825 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3826
3827
3828 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3829 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3830 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3831 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3832 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3833 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3834 }
3835
3836 static unsigned int
3837 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3838 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3839 unsigned int state;
3840 {
3841 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3842 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3843 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3844 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3845
3846 Lisp_Object tem;
3847
3848 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3849 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3850 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3851 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3852 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3853 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3854 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3855 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3856
3857
3858 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3859 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3860 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3861 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3862 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3863 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3864 }
3865
3866 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3867
3868 char *
3869 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
3870 KeySym keysym;
3871 {
3872 char *value;
3873
3874 BLOCK_INPUT;
3875 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3876 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3877
3878 return value;
3879 }
3880
3881
3882 \f
3883 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3884
3885 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3886
3887 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3888 the mouse. */
3889
3890 static Lisp_Object
3891 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
3892 struct input_event *result;
3893 XButtonEvent *event;
3894 struct frame *f;
3895 {
3896 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3897 otherwise. */
3898 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3899 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3900 result->timestamp = event->time;
3901 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3902 event->state)
3903 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3904 ? up_modifier
3905 : down_modifier));
3906
3907 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3908 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3909 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3910 result->arg = Qnil;
3911 return Qnil;
3912 }
3913
3914 \f
3915 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3916 The input handler calls this.
3917
3918 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3919 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3920 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3921 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3922
3923 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3924 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3925
3926 static int
3927 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
3928 FRAME_PTR frame;
3929 XMotionEvent *event;
3930 {
3931 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3932 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3933 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3934
3935 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3936 return 0;
3937
3938 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3939 {
3940 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3941 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3942 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3943 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3944 return 1;
3945 }
3946
3947
3948 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3949 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3950 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3951 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3952 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3953 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3954 {
3955 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3956 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3957 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3958 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3959 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3960 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3961 return 1;
3962 }
3963
3964 return 0;
3965 }
3966
3967 \f
3968 /************************************************************************
3969 Mouse Face
3970 ************************************************************************/
3971
3972 static void
3973 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3974 {
3975 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3976 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3977 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3978 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3979 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3980 }
3981
3982
3983
3984 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3985 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3986
3987 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3988 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3989 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3990 position on the scroll bar.
3991
3992 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3993 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3994 the mouse is over.
3995
3996 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3997 was at this position.
3998
3999 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
4000
4001 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
4002 movement. */
4003
4004 static void
4005 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
4006 FRAME_PTR *fp;
4007 int insist;
4008 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
4009 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
4010 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
4011 unsigned long *time;
4012 {
4013 FRAME_PTR f1;
4014
4015 BLOCK_INPUT;
4016
4017 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
4018 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
4019 else
4020 {
4021 Window root;
4022 int root_x, root_y;
4023
4024 Window dummy_window;
4025 int dummy;
4026
4027 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
4028
4029 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
4030 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4031 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
4032 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
4033 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
4034
4035 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
4036
4037 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
4038 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
4039 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
4040
4041 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
4042 &root,
4043
4044 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
4045 a different screen. */
4046 &dummy_window,
4047
4048 /* The position on that root window. */
4049 &root_x, &root_y,
4050
4051 /* More trash we can't trust. */
4052 &dummy, &dummy,
4053
4054 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
4055 we don't care. */
4056 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
4057
4058 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
4059 containing the pointer. */
4060 {
4061 Window win, child;
4062 int win_x, win_y;
4063 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
4064
4065 win = root;
4066
4067 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
4068 structure is changing at the same time this function
4069 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
4070
4071 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
4072
4073 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
4074 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
4075 {
4076 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
4077 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
4078 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
4079
4080 /* From-window, to-window. */
4081 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
4082
4083 /* From-position, to-position. */
4084 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
4085
4086 /* Child of win. */
4087 &child);
4088 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
4089 }
4090 else
4091 {
4092 while (1)
4093 {
4094 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
4095
4096 /* From-window, to-window. */
4097 root, win,
4098
4099 /* From-position, to-position. */
4100 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
4101
4102 /* Child of win. */
4103 &child);
4104
4105 if (child == None || child == win)
4106 break;
4107
4108 win = child;
4109 parent_x = win_x;
4110 parent_y = win_y;
4111 }
4112
4113 /* Now we know that:
4114 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
4115 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
4116 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
4117 (XTC did this the last time through), and
4118 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
4119 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
4120 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
4121 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
4122 never use them in that case.) */
4123
4124 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4125 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4126
4127 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4128 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4129 on the frame. */
4130 if (f1 != NULL
4131 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4132 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4133 f1 = NULL;
4134 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4135 }
4136
4137 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4138 f1 = 0;
4139
4140 x_uncatch_errors ();
4141
4142 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4143 if (! f1)
4144 {
4145 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4146
4147 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
4148
4149 if (bar)
4150 {
4151 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4152 win_x = parent_x;
4153 win_y = parent_y;
4154 }
4155 }
4156
4157 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4158 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4159
4160 if (f1)
4161 {
4162 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4163 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4164 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4165 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4166 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4167 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4168 the frame are divided into. */
4169
4170 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4171 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4172
4173 *bar_window = Qnil;
4174 *part = 0;
4175 *fp = f1;
4176 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4177 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4178 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
4179 }
4180 }
4181 }
4182
4183 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4184 }
4185
4186
4187 \f
4188 /***********************************************************************
4189 Scroll bars
4190 ***********************************************************************/
4191
4192 /* Scroll bar support. */
4193
4194 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4195 manages it.
4196 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4197 bits. */
4198
4199 static struct scroll_bar *
4200 x_window_to_scroll_bar (display, window_id)
4201 Display *display;
4202 Window window_id;
4203 {
4204 Lisp_Object tail;
4205
4206 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4207 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4208 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4209
4210 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4211 {
4212 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
4213
4214 frame = XCAR (tail);
4215 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4216 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
4217 abort ();
4218
4219 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4220 continue;
4221
4222 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4223 right window ID. */
4224 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4225 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4226 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4227 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4228 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4229 condemned = Qnil,
4230 ! NILP (bar));
4231 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4232 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4233 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4234 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4235 }
4236
4237 return 0;
4238 }
4239
4240
4241 #if defined USE_LUCID
4242
4243 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4244 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4245
4246 static Widget
4247 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
4248 Window window;
4249 {
4250 Lisp_Object tail;
4251
4252 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4253 {
4254 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
4255 {
4256 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
4257 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4258
4259 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4260 return menu_bar;
4261 }
4262 }
4263
4264 return NULL;
4265 }
4266
4267 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4268
4269 \f
4270 /************************************************************************
4271 Toolkit scroll bars
4272 ************************************************************************/
4273
4274 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4275
4276 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
4277 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
4278 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
4279 struct scroll_bar *));
4280 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
4281 int, int, int));
4282
4283
4284 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4285 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4286
4287 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4288
4289 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4290
4291 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4292
4293 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4294 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4295
4296 #ifndef USE_GTK
4297 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4298
4299 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4300
4301 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4302
4303 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4304 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4305 to avoid jerkyness. */
4306
4307 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4308
4309 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4310 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4311 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4312 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4313
4314 static void
4315 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
4316 num_params)
4317 Widget widget;
4318 XtPointer client_data;
4319 String action_name;
4320 XEvent *event;
4321 String *params;
4322 Cardinal *num_params;
4323 {
4324 int scroll_bar_p;
4325 char *end_action;
4326
4327 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4328 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4329 end_action = "Release";
4330 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4331 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4332 end_action = "EndScroll";
4333 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4334
4335 if (scroll_bar_p
4336 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4337 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4338 {
4339 struct window *w;
4340
4341 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4342 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4343 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4344
4345 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4346 {
4347 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4348 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4349 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4350 }
4351 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4352 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4353
4354 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4355 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4356 }
4357 }
4358 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4359
4360 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4361 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4362
4363 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4364 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4365
4366
4367 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4368 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4369 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4370 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4371
4372 static void
4373 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
4374 Lisp_Object window;
4375 int part, portion, whole;
4376 {
4377 XEvent event;
4378 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4379 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4380 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4381 int i;
4382
4383 BLOCK_INPUT;
4384
4385 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4386 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4387 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4388 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4389 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4390 ev->format = 32;
4391
4392 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4393 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4394 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4395 into that array in the event. */
4396 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4397 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4398 break;
4399
4400 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4401 {
4402 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4403 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4404 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4405
4406 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4407 nbytes);
4408 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
4409 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4410 }
4411
4412 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4413 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4414 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4415 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4416 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4417 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4418
4419 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4420 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4421 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4422 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4423 #endif
4424
4425 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4426 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4427 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4428 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4429 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4430 }
4431
4432
4433 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4434 in *IEVENT. */
4435
4436 static void
4437 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
4438 XEvent *event;
4439 struct input_event *ievent;
4440 {
4441 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4442 Lisp_Object window;
4443 struct frame *f;
4444 struct window *w;
4445
4446 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4447 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4448
4449 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4450 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4451
4452 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4453 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4454 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4455 #ifdef USE_GTK
4456 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4457 #else
4458 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4459 #endif
4460 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4461 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4462 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4463 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4464 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4465 }
4466
4467
4468 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4469
4470 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4471
4472 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4473
4474
4475 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4476 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4477 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4478
4479 static void
4480 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4481 Widget widget;
4482 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4483 {
4484 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4485 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4486 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4487
4488 switch (cs->reason)
4489 {
4490 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4491 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4492 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4493 break;
4494
4495 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4496 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4497 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4498 break;
4499
4500 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4501 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4502 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4503 break;
4504
4505 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4506 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4507 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4508 break;
4509
4510 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4511 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4512 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4513 break;
4514
4515 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4516 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4517 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4518 break;
4519
4520 case XmCR_DRAG:
4521 {
4522 int slider_size;
4523
4524 /* Get the slider size. */
4525 BLOCK_INPUT;
4526 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4527 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4528
4529 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4530 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4531 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4532 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4533 }
4534 break;
4535
4536 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4537 break;
4538 };
4539
4540 if (part >= 0)
4541 {
4542 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4543 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4544 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4545 }
4546 }
4547
4548 #elif defined USE_GTK
4549
4550 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4551 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4552
4553 static void
4554 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
4555 GtkRange *widget;
4556 gpointer data;
4557 {
4558 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
4559 gdouble previous;
4560 gdouble position;
4561 gdouble *p;
4562 int diff;
4563
4564 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4565 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget));
4566
4567 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4568
4569 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
4570 if (! p)
4571 {
4572 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
4573 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
4574 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
4575 }
4576
4577 previous = *p;
4578 *p = position;
4579
4580 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
4581
4582 diff = (int) (position - previous);
4583
4584 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4585 {
4586 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4587 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4588 }
4589 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4590 {
4591 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4592 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4593 }
4594 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4595 {
4596 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4597 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4598 }
4599 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4600 {
4601 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4602 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4603 }
4604 else
4605 {
4606 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4607 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
4608 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4609 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4610 }
4611
4612 if (part >= 0)
4613 {
4614 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4615 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4616 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4617 }
4618 }
4619
4620 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4621
4622 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4623 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4624 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4625 the thumb is. */
4626
4627 static void
4628 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4629 Widget widget;
4630 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4631 {
4632 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4633 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4634 float shown;
4635 int whole, portion, height;
4636 int part;
4637
4638 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4639 BLOCK_INPUT;
4640 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4641 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4642
4643 whole = 10000000;
4644 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4645
4646 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4647 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4648 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4649 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4650 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4651 bottom). */
4652 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4653 else
4654 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4655
4656 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4657 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4658 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4659 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4660 }
4661
4662
4663 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4664 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4665 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4666 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4667 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4668 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4669 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4670
4671 static void
4672 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4673 Widget widget;
4674 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4675 {
4676 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4677 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4678 int position = (long) call_data;
4679 Dimension height;
4680 int part;
4681
4682 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4683 BLOCK_INPUT;
4684 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4685 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4686
4687 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4688 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4689
4690 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4691 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4692 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4693 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4694 else
4695 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4696
4697 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4698 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4699 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4700 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4701 }
4702
4703 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4704
4705 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4706
4707 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4708 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4709
4710 #ifdef USE_GTK
4711 static void
4712 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4713 struct frame *f;
4714 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4715 {
4716 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4717
4718 BLOCK_INPUT;
4719 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4720 scroll_bar_name);
4721 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4722 }
4723
4724 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4725
4726 static void
4727 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4728 struct frame *f;
4729 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4730 {
4731 Window xwindow;
4732 Widget widget;
4733 Arg av[20];
4734 int ac = 0;
4735 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4736 unsigned long pixel;
4737
4738 BLOCK_INPUT;
4739
4740 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4741 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4742 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4743 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4744 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4745 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4746 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4747 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4748 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4749
4750 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4751 if (pixel != -1)
4752 {
4753 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4754 ++ac;
4755 }
4756
4757 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4758 if (pixel != -1)
4759 {
4760 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4761 ++ac;
4762 }
4763
4764 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4765 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4766
4767 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4768 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4769 (XtPointer) bar);
4770 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4771 (XtPointer) bar);
4772 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4773 (XtPointer) bar);
4774 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4775 (XtPointer) bar);
4776 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4777 (XtPointer) bar);
4778 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4779 (XtPointer) bar);
4780 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4781 (XtPointer) bar);
4782
4783 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4784 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4785
4786 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4787 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4788 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4789 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4790
4791 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4792
4793 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4794 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4795 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4796 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4797 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4798 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4799 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4800 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4801
4802 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4803 if (pixel != -1)
4804 {
4805 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4806 ++ac;
4807 }
4808
4809 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4810 if (pixel != -1)
4811 {
4812 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4813 ++ac;
4814 }
4815
4816 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4817
4818 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4819 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4820 {
4821 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4822 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4823 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4824 pixel = -1;
4825 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4826 }
4827 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4828 {
4829 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4830 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4831 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4832 pixel = -1;
4833 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4834 }
4835
4836 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4837 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4838 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4839 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4840 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4841 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4842 {
4843 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
4844 ++ac;
4845 }
4846 else
4847 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4848 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4849 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4850 {
4851 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4852 the shadows. */
4853 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4854 ++ac;
4855
4856 /* Specify the colors. */
4857 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4858 if (pixel != -1)
4859 {
4860 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4861 ++ac;
4862 }
4863 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4864 if (pixel != -1)
4865 {
4866 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4867 ++ac;
4868 }
4869 }
4870 #endif
4871
4872 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4873 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4874
4875 {
4876 char *initial = "";
4877 char *val = initial;
4878 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4879 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4880 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4881 #endif
4882 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4883 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4884 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4885 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4886 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4887 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4888 }
4889 }
4890
4891 /* Define callbacks. */
4892 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4893 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4894 (XtPointer) bar);
4895
4896 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4897 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4898
4899 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4900
4901 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4902 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4903 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4904 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4905
4906 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4907 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4908 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4909 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4910
4911 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4912 }
4913 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4914
4915
4916 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4917 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4918
4919 #ifdef USE_GTK
4920 static void
4921 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4922 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4923 int portion, position, whole;
4924 {
4925 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4926 }
4927
4928 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4929 static void
4930 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4931 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4932 int portion, position, whole;
4933 {
4934 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4935 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4936 float top, shown;
4937
4938 BLOCK_INPUT;
4939
4940 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4941
4942 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4943 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4944 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4945 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4946 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4947 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4948 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4949 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4950 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4951 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4952 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4953 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4954 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4955 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4956 whole += portion;
4957
4958 if (whole <= 0)
4959 top = 0, shown = 1;
4960 else
4961 {
4962 top = (float) position / whole;
4963 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4964 }
4965
4966 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4967 {
4968 int size, value;
4969
4970 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4971 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4972 value. */
4973 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4974 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4975 size = max (size, 1);
4976
4977 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4978 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4979 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4980
4981 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4982 }
4983 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4984
4985 if (whole == 0)
4986 top = 0, shown = 1;
4987 else
4988 {
4989 top = (float) position / whole;
4990 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4991 }
4992
4993 {
4994 float old_top, old_shown;
4995 Dimension height;
4996 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4997 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4998 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4999 XtNheight, &height,
5000 NULL);
5001
5002 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
5003 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
5004 top = max (0, min (1, top));
5005 else
5006 top = old_top;
5007 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
5008 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
5009
5010 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
5011 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
5012 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
5013 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
5014 {
5015 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5016 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
5017 else
5018 {
5019 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
5020 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
5021 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
5022
5023 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
5024 }
5025 }
5026 }
5027 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
5028
5029 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5030 }
5031 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5032
5033 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5034
5035
5036 \f
5037 /************************************************************************
5038 Scroll bars, general
5039 ************************************************************************/
5040
5041 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
5042 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
5043 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
5044 scroll bar. */
5045
5046 static struct scroll_bar *
5047 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
5048 struct window *w;
5049 int top, left, width, height;
5050 {
5051 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5052 struct scroll_bar *bar
5053 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
5054
5055 BLOCK_INPUT;
5056
5057 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5058 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
5059 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5060 {
5061 XSetWindowAttributes a;
5062 unsigned long mask;
5063 Window window;
5064
5065 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
5066 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
5067 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
5068
5069 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
5070 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
5071 | ExposureMask);
5072 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
5073
5074 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
5075
5076 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
5077 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
5078 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
5079 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5080 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5081 left, top, width,
5082 window_box_height (w), False);
5083
5084 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5085 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
5086 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5087 top,
5088 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5089 height,
5090 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
5091 0,
5092 CopyFromParent,
5093 CopyFromParent,
5094 CopyFromParent,
5095 /* Attributes. */
5096 mask, &a);
5097 bar->x_window = window;
5098 }
5099 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5100
5101 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
5102 bar->top = top;
5103 bar->left = left;
5104 bar->width = width;
5105 bar->height = height;
5106 bar->start = 0;
5107 bar->end = 0;
5108 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5109 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
5110
5111 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
5112 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5113 bar->prev = Qnil;
5114 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5115 if (!NILP (bar->next))
5116 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5117
5118 /* Map the window/widget. */
5119 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5120 {
5121 #ifdef USE_GTK
5122 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5123 bar->x_window,
5124 top,
5125 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5126 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5127 max (height, 1));
5128 xg_show_scroll_bar (bar->x_window);
5129 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5130 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
5131 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
5132 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5133 top,
5134 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5135 max (height, 1), 0);
5136 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
5137 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5138 }
5139 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5140 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5141 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5142
5143 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5144 return bar;
5145 }
5146
5147
5148 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5149
5150 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5151
5152 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5153 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5154 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5155 events.)
5156
5157 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5158 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5159 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5160 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5161 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5162
5163 static void
5164 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
5165 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5166 int start, end;
5167 int rebuild;
5168 {
5169 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5170 Window w = bar->x_window;
5171 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5172 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5173
5174 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5175 if (! rebuild
5176 && start == bar->start
5177 && end == bar->end)
5178 return;
5179
5180 BLOCK_INPUT;
5181
5182 {
5183 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5184 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5185 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5186
5187 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5188 the distance between start and end. */
5189 {
5190 int length = end - start;
5191
5192 if (start < 0)
5193 start = 0;
5194 else if (start > top_range)
5195 start = top_range;
5196 end = start + length;
5197
5198 if (end < start)
5199 end = start;
5200 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5201 end = top_range;
5202 }
5203
5204 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5205 bar->start = start;
5206 bar->end = end;
5207
5208 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5209 if (end > top_range)
5210 end = top_range;
5211
5212 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5213 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5214 that many pixels tall. */
5215 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5216
5217 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5218 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5219 if (0 < start)
5220 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5221 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5222 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5223 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5224 inside_width, start,
5225 False);
5226
5227 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5228 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5229 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5230 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5231
5232 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5233 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5234 /* x, y, width, height */
5235 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5236 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5237 inside_width, end - start);
5238
5239 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5240 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5241 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5242 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5243
5244 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5245 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5246 if (end < inside_height)
5247 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5248 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5249 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5250 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5251 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5252 False);
5253
5254 }
5255
5256 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5257 }
5258
5259 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5260
5261 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5262 nil. */
5263
5264 static void
5265 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
5266 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5267 {
5268 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5269 BLOCK_INPUT;
5270
5271 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5272 #ifdef USE_GTK
5273 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5274 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5275 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5276 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5277 #else
5278 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5279 #endif
5280
5281 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5282 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5283
5284 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5285 }
5286
5287
5288 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5289 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5290 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5291 create one. */
5292
5293 static void
5294 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
5295 struct window *w;
5296 int portion, whole, position;
5297 {
5298 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5299 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5300 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5301 int window_y, window_height;
5302 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5303 int fringe_extended_p;
5304 #endif
5305
5306 /* Get window dimensions. */
5307 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5308 top = window_y;
5309 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5310 height = window_height;
5311
5312 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5313 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5314
5315 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5316 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5317 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5318 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5319 else
5320 sb_width = width;
5321
5322 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5323 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5324 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5325 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5326 else
5327 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5328 #else
5329 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5330 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5331 else
5332 sb_left = left;
5333 #endif
5334
5335 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5336 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5337 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5338 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5339 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5340 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5341 else
5342 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5343 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5344 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5345 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5346 #endif
5347
5348 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5349 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5350 {
5351 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5352 {
5353 BLOCK_INPUT;
5354 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5355 if (fringe_extended_p)
5356 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5357 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5358 else
5359 #endif
5360 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5361 left, top, width, height, False);
5362 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5363 }
5364
5365 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5366 }
5367 else
5368 {
5369 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5370 unsigned int mask = 0;
5371
5372 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5373
5374 BLOCK_INPUT;
5375
5376 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5377 mask |= CWX;
5378 if (top != bar->top)
5379 mask |= CWY;
5380 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5381 mask |= CWWidth;
5382 if (height != bar->height)
5383 mask |= CWHeight;
5384
5385 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5386
5387 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5388 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5389 {
5390 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5391 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5392 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5393 {
5394 if (fringe_extended_p)
5395 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5396 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5397 else
5398 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5399 left, top, width, height, False);
5400 }
5401 #ifdef USE_GTK
5402 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5403 bar->x_window,
5404 top,
5405 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5406 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5407 max (height, 1));
5408 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5409 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5410 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5411 top,
5412 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5413 max (height, 1), 0);
5414 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5415 }
5416 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5417
5418 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5419 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5420 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5421 {
5422 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5423 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5424 height, False);
5425 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5426 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5427 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5428 height, False);
5429 }
5430
5431 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5432 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5433 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5434 example. */
5435 {
5436 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5437 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5438 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5439 {
5440 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5441 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5442 left + area_width - rest, top,
5443 rest, height, False);
5444 else
5445 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5446 left, top, rest, height, False);
5447 }
5448 }
5449
5450 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5451 if (mask)
5452 {
5453 XWindowChanges wc;
5454
5455 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5456 wc.y = top;
5457 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5458 wc.height = height;
5459 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5460 mask, &wc);
5461 }
5462
5463 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5464
5465 /* Remember new settings. */
5466 bar->left = sb_left;
5467 bar->top = top;
5468 bar->width = sb_width;
5469 bar->height = height;
5470
5471 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5472 }
5473
5474 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5475 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5476
5477 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5478 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5479 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5480 dragged. */
5481 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5482 {
5483 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5484
5485 if (whole == 0)
5486 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5487 else
5488 {
5489 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5490 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5491 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5492 }
5493 }
5494 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5495
5496 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5497 }
5498
5499
5500 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5501 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5502 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5503 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5504 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5505 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5506 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5507
5508 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5509 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5510 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5511
5512 static void
5513 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
5514 FRAME_PTR frame;
5515 {
5516 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5517 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5518 {
5519 Lisp_Object bar;
5520 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5521 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5522 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5523 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5524 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5525 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5526 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5527 }
5528 }
5529
5530
5531 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5532 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5533
5534 static void
5535 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
5536 struct window *window;
5537 {
5538 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5539 struct frame *f;
5540
5541 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5542 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5543 abort ();
5544
5545 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5546
5547 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5548 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5549 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5550 {
5551 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5552 the lists. */
5553 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5554 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5555 return;
5556 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5557 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5558 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5559 else
5560 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5561 one or the other! */
5562 abort ();
5563 }
5564 else
5565 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5566
5567 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5568 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5569
5570 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5571 bar->prev = Qnil;
5572 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5573 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5574 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5575 }
5576
5577 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5578 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5579
5580 static void
5581 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
5582 FRAME_PTR f;
5583 {
5584 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5585
5586 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5587
5588 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5589 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5590 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5591
5592 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5593 {
5594 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5595
5596 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5597
5598 next = b->next;
5599 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5600 }
5601
5602 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5603 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5604 }
5605
5606
5607 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5608 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5609 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5610
5611 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5612 mark bits. */
5613
5614 static void
5615 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
5616 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5617 XEvent *event;
5618 {
5619 Window w = bar->x_window;
5620 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5621 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5622 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5623
5624 BLOCK_INPUT;
5625
5626 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5627
5628 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5629 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5630 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5631 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5632
5633 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5634 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5635
5636 /* x, y, width, height */
5637 0, 0,
5638 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5639 bar->height - 1);
5640
5641 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5642 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5643 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5644 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5645
5646 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5647
5648 }
5649 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5650
5651 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5652 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5653
5654 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5655 mark bits. */
5656
5657
5658 static void
5659 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
5660 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5661 XEvent *event;
5662 struct input_event *emacs_event;
5663 {
5664 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5665 abort ();
5666
5667 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5668 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5669 emacs_event->modifiers
5670 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5671 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5672 event->xbutton.state)
5673 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5674 ? up_modifier
5675 : down_modifier));
5676 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5677 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5678 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5679 {
5680 #if 0
5681 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5682 int internal_height
5683 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5684 #endif
5685 int top_range
5686 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5687 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5688
5689 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5690 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5691
5692 if (y < bar->start)
5693 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5694 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5695 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5696 else
5697 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5698
5699 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
5700 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
5701 whether or not we're dragging. */
5702 #if 0
5703 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
5704 holding it. */
5705 if (event->type == ButtonPress
5706 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5707 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - bar->start);
5708 #endif
5709
5710 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5711 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5712 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5713 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5714 {
5715 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5716 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5717
5718 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5719 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5720 }
5721 #endif
5722
5723 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
5724 #if 0
5725 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
5726 the handle. */
5727 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5728 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
5729 else
5730 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5731 #else
5732 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5733 #endif
5734
5735 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5736 }
5737 }
5738
5739 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5740
5741 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5742
5743 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5744 mark bits. */
5745
5746 static void
5747 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
5748 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5749 XEvent *event;
5750 {
5751 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5752
5753 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5754
5755 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5756 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5757
5758 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5759 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5760 {
5761 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5762 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5763
5764 if (new_start != bar->start)
5765 {
5766 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5767
5768 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5769 }
5770 }
5771 }
5772
5773 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5774
5775 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5776 on the scroll bar. */
5777
5778 static void
5779 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
5780 FRAME_PTR *fp;
5781 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
5782 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
5783 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
5784 unsigned long *time;
5785 {
5786 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5787 Window w = bar->x_window;
5788 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5789 int win_x, win_y;
5790 Window dummy_window;
5791 int dummy_coord;
5792 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5793
5794 BLOCK_INPUT;
5795
5796 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5797 report that. */
5798 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5799
5800 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5801 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5802 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5803
5804 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5805 &win_x, &win_y,
5806
5807 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5808 &dummy_mask))
5809 ;
5810 else
5811 {
5812 #if 0
5813 int inside_height
5814 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5815 #endif
5816 int top_range
5817 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5818
5819 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5820
5821 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5822 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5823
5824 if (win_y < 0)
5825 win_y = 0;
5826 if (win_y > top_range)
5827 win_y = top_range;
5828
5829 *fp = f;
5830 *bar_window = bar->window;
5831
5832 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5833 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5834 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5835 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5836 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5837 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5838 else
5839 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5840
5841 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5842 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5843
5844 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5845 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5846 }
5847
5848 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5849
5850 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5851 }
5852
5853
5854 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5855 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5856 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5857 redraw them. */
5858
5859 void
5860 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
5861 FRAME_PTR f;
5862 {
5863 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5864 Lisp_Object bar;
5865
5866 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5867 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5868 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5869 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5870 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5871 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5872 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5873 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5874 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5875 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5876 }
5877
5878 \f
5879 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5880
5881 #if 0
5882 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
5883 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
5884 sometimes don't work. */
5885
5886 static Time enter_timestamp;
5887 #endif
5888
5889 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5890 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5891 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5892 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5893
5894 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5895 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5896
5897 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5898
5899 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5900 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5901
5902 static int temp_index;
5903 static short temp_buffer[100];
5904
5905 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5906 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5907 temp_index = 0; \
5908 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5909
5910 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5911 on a particular display. */
5912
5913 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5914
5915 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5916 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5917 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5918 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5919
5920 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5921
5922 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5923 do \
5924 { \
5925 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5926 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5927 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5928 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5929 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5930 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5931 } \
5932 while (0)
5933
5934 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5935 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5936
5937
5938 enum
5939 {
5940 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5941 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5942 X_EVENT_DROP
5943 };
5944
5945 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5946 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5947 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5948
5949 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5950 this event further.
5951 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5952
5953 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5954 static int
5955 x_filter_event (dpyinfo, event)
5956 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5957 XEvent *event;
5958 {
5959 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5960 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5961 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5962 was created. */
5963
5964 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5965 event->xclient.window);
5966
5967 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5968 }
5969 #endif
5970
5971 #ifdef USE_GTK
5972 static int current_count;
5973 static int current_finish;
5974 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5975
5976 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5977 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5978 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5979 static GdkFilterReturn
5980 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
5981 GdkXEvent *gxev;
5982 GdkEvent *ev;
5983 gpointer data;
5984 {
5985 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5986
5987 if (current_count >= 0)
5988 {
5989 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5990
5991 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5992
5993 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5994 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5995 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5996 so we do it here. */
5997 if (xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5998 if (dpyinfo && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5999 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
6000 #endif
6001
6002 if (! dpyinfo)
6003 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6004 else
6005 {
6006 current_count +=
6007 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
6008 current_hold_quit);
6009 }
6010 }
6011 else
6012 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
6013
6014 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
6015 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
6016
6017 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
6018 }
6019 #endif /* USE_GTK */
6020
6021
6022 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
6023
6024 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
6025 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
6026 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
6027
6028 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
6029
6030 static int
6031 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, finish, hold_quit)
6032 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6033 XEvent *eventp;
6034 int *finish;
6035 struct input_event *hold_quit;
6036 {
6037 union {
6038 struct input_event ie;
6039 struct selection_input_event sie;
6040 } inev;
6041 int count = 0;
6042 int do_help = 0;
6043 int nbytes = 0;
6044 struct frame *f = NULL;
6045 struct coding_system coding;
6046 XEvent event = *eventp;
6047
6048 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6049
6050 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
6051 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
6052 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
6053
6054 switch (event.type)
6055 {
6056 case ClientMessage:
6057 {
6058 if (event.xclient.message_type
6059 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
6060 && event.xclient.format == 32)
6061 {
6062 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
6063 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
6064 {
6065 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
6066 could be the shell widget window
6067 if the frame has no title bar. */
6068 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6069 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6070 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
6071 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
6072 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
6073 #endif
6074 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
6075 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
6076 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
6077 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
6078 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
6079 needed.
6080
6081 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
6082 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
6083 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
6084 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
6085 Emacs. */
6086
6087 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
6088 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
6089 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
6090 if (f)
6091 {
6092 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
6093 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
6094 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
6095 x_catch_errors (d);
6096 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
6097 /* The ICCCM says this is
6098 the only valid choice. */
6099 RevertToParent,
6100 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
6101 /* This is needed to detect the error
6102 if there is an error. */
6103 XSync (d, False);
6104 x_uncatch_errors ();
6105 }
6106 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
6107 #endif /* 0 */
6108 goto done;
6109 }
6110
6111 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
6112 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
6113 {
6114 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
6115 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
6116 the session manager, who's looking for such a
6117 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
6118 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
6119 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
6120 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
6121 session manager and one for this. */
6122 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
6123 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
6124 #endif
6125 {
6126 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
6127 event.xclient.window);
6128 /* This is just so we only give real data once
6129 for a single Emacs process. */
6130 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
6131 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
6132 event.xclient.window,
6133 initial_argv, initial_argc);
6134 else if (f)
6135 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
6136 event.xclient.window,
6137 0, 0);
6138 }
6139 goto done;
6140 }
6141
6142 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
6143 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
6144 {
6145 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
6146 event.xclient.window);
6147 if (!f)
6148 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
6149
6150 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
6151 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6152 goto done;
6153 }
6154
6155 goto done;
6156 }
6157
6158 if (event.xclient.message_type
6159 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
6160 {
6161 goto done;
6162 }
6163
6164 if (event.xclient.message_type
6165 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
6166 {
6167 int new_x, new_y;
6168 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6169
6170 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
6171 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
6172
6173 if (f)
6174 {
6175 f->left_pos = new_x;
6176 f->top_pos = new_y;
6177 }
6178 goto done;
6179 }
6180
6181 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
6182 if (event.xclient.message_type
6183 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
6184 {
6185 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6186 if (f)
6187 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
6188 &event, NULL);
6189 goto done;
6190 }
6191 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6192
6193 if ((event.xclient.message_type
6194 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
6195 || (event.xclient.message_type
6196 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
6197 {
6198 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6199 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6200 currently never do because we are interested in
6201 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6202 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
6203 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6204 if (!f)
6205 goto OTHER;
6206 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6207 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6208 goto done;
6209 }
6210
6211 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6212 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6213 we construct an input_event. */
6214 if (event.xclient.message_type
6215 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6216 {
6217 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6218 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6219 goto done;
6220 }
6221 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6222
6223 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6224 if (event.xclient.message_type
6225 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6226 {
6227 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6228 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6229 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6230
6231 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6232 goto done;
6233 }
6234
6235 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6236 if (!f)
6237 goto OTHER;
6238 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6239 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6240 }
6241 break;
6242
6243 case SelectionNotify:
6244 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6245 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6246 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6247 goto OTHER;
6248 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6249 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6250 break;
6251
6252 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6253 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6254 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6255 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6256 goto OTHER;
6257 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6258 {
6259 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
6260
6261 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6262 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6263 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6264 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6265 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6266 }
6267 break;
6268
6269 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6270 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6271 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6272 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6273 goto OTHER;
6274 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6275 {
6276 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
6277 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
6278
6279 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6280 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6281 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6282 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6283 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6284 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6285 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6286 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6287 }
6288 break;
6289
6290 case PropertyNotify:
6291 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6292 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
6293 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
6294 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
6295 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
6296 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
6297 goto OTHER;
6298 #endif
6299 #endif
6300 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6301 goto OTHER;
6302
6303 case ReparentNotify:
6304 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6305 if (f)
6306 {
6307 int x, y;
6308 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6309 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6310 f->left_pos = x;
6311 f->top_pos = y;
6312
6313 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6314 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6315 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6316 }
6317 goto OTHER;
6318
6319 case Expose:
6320 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6321 if (f)
6322 {
6323 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6324
6325 #ifdef USE_GTK
6326 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6327 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6328 event.xexpose.window,
6329 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6330 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6331 FALSE);
6332 #endif
6333 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6334 {
6335 f->async_visible = 1;
6336 f->async_iconified = 0;
6337 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6338 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6339 }
6340 else
6341 expose_frame (f,
6342 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6343 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6344 }
6345 else
6346 {
6347 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6348 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6349 #endif
6350 #if defined USE_LUCID
6351 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6352 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6353 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6354 {
6355 Widget widget
6356 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6357 if (widget)
6358 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6359 }
6360 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6361
6362 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6363 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6364 goto OTHER;
6365 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6366 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6367 event.xexpose.window);
6368
6369 if (bar)
6370 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6371 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6372 else
6373 goto OTHER;
6374 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6375 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6376 }
6377 break;
6378
6379 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6380 source area was obscured or not
6381 available. */
6382 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6383 if (f)
6384 {
6385 expose_frame (f,
6386 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6387 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6388 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6389 }
6390 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6391 else
6392 goto OTHER;
6393 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6394 break;
6395
6396 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6397 source area was completely
6398 available. */
6399 break;
6400
6401 case UnmapNotify:
6402 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6403 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6404 {
6405 tip_window = 0;
6406 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6407 }
6408
6409 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6410 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6411 the frame was deleted. */
6412 {
6413 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6414 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6415 display that won't ever be seen. */
6416 f->async_visible = 0;
6417 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6418 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6419 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6420 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6421 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6422 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6423 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6424 {
6425 f->async_iconified = 1;
6426
6427 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6428 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6429 }
6430 }
6431 goto OTHER;
6432
6433 case MapNotify:
6434 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6435 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6436 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6437 goto OTHER;
6438
6439 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6440 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6441 frame is visible. */
6442 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6443 if (f)
6444 {
6445 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6446 the frame's display structures.
6447 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6448 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6449 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6450 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6451 if (! f->async_iconified)
6452 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6453
6454 f->async_visible = 1;
6455 f->async_iconified = 0;
6456 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6457
6458 if (f->iconified)
6459 {
6460 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6461 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6462 }
6463 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6464 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6465 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6466 to update the frame titles
6467 in case this is the second frame. */
6468 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6469 }
6470 goto OTHER;
6471
6472 case KeyPress:
6473
6474 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6475 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6476
6477 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6478 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6479 if (popup_activated ())
6480 goto OTHER;
6481 #endif
6482
6483 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6484
6485 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6486 mouse highlighting. */
6487 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6488 && (f == 0
6489 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6490 {
6491 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6492 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6493 }
6494
6495 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6496 if (f == 0)
6497 {
6498 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6499 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6500 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6501 event.xkey.window);
6502 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6503 {
6504 widget = XtParent (widget);
6505 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6506 }
6507 }
6508 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6509
6510 if (f != 0)
6511 {
6512 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6513 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6514 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6515 his Emacs hang.
6516
6517 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6518 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6519 status_return even if the input is too long to
6520 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6521 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6522 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6523 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6524 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6525 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6526 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6527 int modifiers;
6528 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6529 Lisp_Object c;
6530
6531 #ifdef USE_GTK
6532 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6533 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6534 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6535 (see above). */
6536 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6537 #endif
6538
6539 event.xkey.state
6540 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6541 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6542 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6543
6544 /* This will have to go some day... */
6545
6546 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6547 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6548 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6549 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6550 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6551 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6552 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6553
6554 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6555 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6556 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6557 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6558 not it is combined with Meta. */
6559 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6560 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6561
6562 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6563 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6564 {
6565 Status status_return;
6566
6567 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6568 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6569 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6570 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6571 &status_return);
6572 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6573 {
6574 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6575 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6576 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6577 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6578 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6579 &status_return);
6580 }
6581 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6582 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
6583 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
6584 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
6585 coding_system = Qutf_8;
6586 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6587 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6588 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6589 &status_return);
6590 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6591 {
6592 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6593 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6594 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6595 &event.xkey,
6596 copy_bufptr,
6597 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6598 &status_return);
6599 }
6600 }
6601 #endif
6602
6603 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6604 break;
6605 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6606 {
6607 keysym = NoSymbol;
6608 modifiers = 0;
6609 }
6610 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6611 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6612 abort ();
6613 }
6614 else
6615 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6616 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6617 &compose_status);
6618 #else
6619 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6620 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6621 &compose_status);
6622 #endif
6623
6624 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6625 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6626 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6627 break;
6628
6629 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6630 orig_keysym = keysym;
6631
6632 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6633 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6634 inev.ie.modifiers
6635 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6636 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6637
6638 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6639 translations to characters. */
6640 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6641 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6642 {
6643 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6644 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6645 goto done_keysym;
6646 }
6647
6648 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6649 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6650 {
6651 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6652 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6653 else
6654 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6655 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6656 goto done_keysym;
6657 }
6658
6659 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6660 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6661 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6662 Vx_keysym_table,
6663 Qnil))))
6664 {
6665 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6666 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6667 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6668 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6669 goto done_keysym;
6670 }
6671
6672 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6673 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6674 || keysym == XK_Delete
6675 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6676 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6677 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6678 #endif
6679 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6680 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6681 #ifdef HPUX
6682 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6683 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6684 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6685 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6686 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6687 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6688 #endif
6689 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6690 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6691 #endif
6692 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6693 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6694 #endif
6695 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6696 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6697 #endif
6698 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6699 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6700 #endif
6701 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6702 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6703 #endif
6704 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6705 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6706 #endif
6707 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6708 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6709 #endif
6710 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6711 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6712 #endif
6713 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6714 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6715 #endif
6716 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6717 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6718 #endif
6719 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6720 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6721 #endif
6722 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6723 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6724 #endif
6725 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6726 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6727 #endif
6728 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6729 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6730 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6731 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6732 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6733 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6734 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6735 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6736 don't have real modifiers but
6737 should be treated similarly to
6738 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6739 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6740 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6741 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6742 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6743 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6744 #endif
6745 ))
6746 {
6747 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6748 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6749 key. */
6750 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6751 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6752 goto done_keysym;
6753 }
6754
6755 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6756 register int i;
6757 register int c;
6758 int nchars, len;
6759
6760 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6761 {
6762 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6763 nchars++;
6764 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6765 }
6766
6767 if (nchars < nbytes)
6768 {
6769 /* Decode the input data. */
6770 int require;
6771 unsigned char *p;
6772
6773 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6774 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6775 we used just above and the locale. */
6776 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6777 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6778 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6779 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6780 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6781 gives us composition information. */
6782 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6783
6784 require = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6785 coding.destination = alloca (require);
6786 coding.dst_bytes = require;
6787 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6788 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6789 nbytes = coding.produced;
6790 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6791 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6792 }
6793
6794 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6795 character events. */
6796 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6797 {
6798 if (nchars == nbytes)
6799 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6800 else
6801 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
6802 nbytes - i, len);
6803 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6804 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6805 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6806 inev.ie.code = c;
6807 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6808 }
6809
6810 count += nchars;
6811
6812 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6813
6814 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6815 break;
6816 }
6817 }
6818 done_keysym:
6819 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6820 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6821 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6822 client. */
6823 break;
6824 #else
6825 goto OTHER;
6826 #endif
6827
6828 case KeyRelease:
6829 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6830 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6831 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6832 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6833 client. */
6834 break;
6835 #else
6836 goto OTHER;
6837 #endif
6838
6839 case EnterNotify:
6840 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6841 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6842
6843 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6844
6845 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6846 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6847
6848 #if 0
6849 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
6850 {
6851 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
6852 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
6853 || !(f->auto_lower)
6854 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
6855 {
6856 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
6857 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
6858 }
6859 }
6860 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6861 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
6862 #endif
6863
6864 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6865 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6866 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6867 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6868 #ifdef USE_GTK
6869 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6870 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6871 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6872 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6873 #endif
6874 goto OTHER;
6875
6876 case FocusIn:
6877 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6878 goto OTHER;
6879
6880 case LeaveNotify:
6881 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6882 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6883
6884 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6885 if (f)
6886 {
6887 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6888 {
6889 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6890 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6891 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6892 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6893 }
6894
6895 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6896 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6897 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6898 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6899 if (any_help_event_p)
6900 do_help = -1;
6901 }
6902 #ifdef USE_GTK
6903 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6904 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6905 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6906 #endif
6907 goto OTHER;
6908
6909 case FocusOut:
6910 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6911 goto OTHER;
6912
6913 case MotionNotify:
6914 {
6915 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6916 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6917 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6918
6919 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6920 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6921 f = last_mouse_frame;
6922 else
6923 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6924
6925 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6926 {
6927 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6928 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6929 }
6930
6931 if (f)
6932 {
6933
6934 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
6935 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window))
6936 {
6937 Lisp_Object window;
6938
6939 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6940 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6941 0, 0, 0, 0);
6942
6943 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6944 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6945 will be selected only when it is active. */
6946 if (WINDOWP (window)
6947 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6948 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6949 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6950 create event iff we don't leave the
6951 selected frame. */
6952 && (focus_follows_mouse
6953 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6954 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6955 {
6956 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6957 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6958 }
6959
6960 last_window=window;
6961 }
6962 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6963 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6964 }
6965 else
6966 {
6967 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6968 struct scroll_bar *bar
6969 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6970 event.xmotion.window);
6971
6972 if (bar)
6973 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6974 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6975
6976 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6977 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6978 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6979 }
6980
6981 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6982 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6983 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6984 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6985 do_help = 1;
6986 goto OTHER;
6987 }
6988
6989 case ConfigureNotify:
6990 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6991 #ifdef USE_GTK
6992 if (!f
6993 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6994 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6995 {
6996 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6997 event.xconfigure.height);
6998 f = 0;
6999 }
7000 #endif
7001 if (f)
7002 {
7003 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7004 #ifndef USE_GTK
7005 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
7006 do this one, the right one will come later.
7007 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
7008 need to reset it below. */
7009 int dont_resize
7010 = ((f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
7011 && f->new_text_cols != 0);
7012 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
7013 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
7014
7015 if (dont_resize)
7016 goto OTHER;
7017
7018 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
7019 is called by the code that handles resizing
7020 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
7021
7022 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
7023 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
7024 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
7025 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
7026 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
7027 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
7028 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
7029 {
7030 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
7031 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
7032 cancel_mouse_face (f);
7033 }
7034
7035 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
7036 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
7037 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7038 #endif
7039
7040 #ifdef USE_GTK
7041 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
7042 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
7043 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
7044 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
7045 #endif
7046 {
7047 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
7048
7049 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
7050 f->want_fullscreen &= ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
7051 }
7052
7053 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7054 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
7055 xic_set_statusarea (f);
7056 #endif
7057
7058 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
7059 {
7060 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
7061 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
7062 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
7063 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
7064 }
7065 }
7066 goto OTHER;
7067
7068 case ButtonRelease:
7069 case ButtonPress:
7070 {
7071 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
7072 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
7073 int tool_bar_p = 0;
7074
7075 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
7076 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
7077 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
7078
7079 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
7080 && last_mouse_frame
7081 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
7082 f = last_mouse_frame;
7083 else
7084 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
7085
7086 if (f)
7087 {
7088 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
7089 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
7090 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
7091 {
7092 Lisp_Object window;
7093 int x = event.xbutton.x;
7094 int y = event.xbutton.y;
7095
7096 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
7097 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
7098
7099 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
7100 {
7101 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
7102 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
7103 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
7104 event.xbutton.state));
7105 }
7106 }
7107
7108 if (!tool_bar_p)
7109 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
7110 if (! popup_activated ())
7111 #endif
7112 {
7113 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
7114 {
7115 if (event.type == ButtonPress
7116 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
7117 {
7118 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
7119 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
7120 }
7121 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
7122 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
7123 }
7124 else
7125 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
7126 }
7127 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
7128 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
7129 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
7130 }
7131 else
7132 {
7133 struct scroll_bar *bar
7134 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
7135 event.xbutton.window);
7136
7137 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
7138 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
7139 scroll bars. */
7140 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
7141 {
7142 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
7143 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
7144 }
7145 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7146 if (bar)
7147 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
7148 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7149 }
7150
7151 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
7152 {
7153 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
7154 last_mouse_frame = f;
7155
7156 if (!tool_bar_p)
7157 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
7158 }
7159 else
7160 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
7161
7162 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
7163 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
7164 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
7165 if (f != 0)
7166 f->mouse_moved = 0;
7167
7168 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
7169 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
7170 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
7171 don't pass it to Xt right now.
7172 Instead, save it away
7173 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
7174 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
7175 if (
7176 #ifdef USE_GTK
7177 ! popup_activated ()
7178 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
7179 && event.xbutton.button < 3
7180 &&
7181 #endif
7182 f && event.type == ButtonPress
7183 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
7184 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
7185 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
7186 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
7187 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
7188 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
7189 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
7190 {
7191 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
7192 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
7193 #ifdef USE_GTK
7194 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
7195 #endif
7196 }
7197 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
7198 {
7199 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
7200 goto OTHER;
7201 }
7202
7203 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
7204 but I am trying to be cautious. */
7205 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
7206 {
7207 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
7208 {
7209 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
7210 if (f->output_data.x)
7211 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
7212 }
7213 else
7214 goto OTHER;
7215 }
7216 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
7217 else
7218 goto OTHER;
7219 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
7220 }
7221 break;
7222
7223 case CirculateNotify:
7224 goto OTHER;
7225
7226 case CirculateRequest:
7227 goto OTHER;
7228
7229 case VisibilityNotify:
7230 goto OTHER;
7231
7232 case MappingNotify:
7233 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
7234 local cache. */
7235 switch (event.xmapping.request)
7236 {
7237 case MappingModifier:
7238 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
7239 /* This is meant to fall through. */
7240 case MappingKeyboard:
7241 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
7242 }
7243 goto OTHER;
7244
7245 default:
7246 OTHER:
7247 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7248 BLOCK_INPUT;
7249 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7250 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7251 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7252 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7253 break;
7254 }
7255
7256 done:
7257 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7258 {
7259 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7260 count++;
7261 }
7262
7263 if (do_help
7264 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7265 {
7266 Lisp_Object frame;
7267
7268 if (f)
7269 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7270 else
7271 frame = Qnil;
7272
7273 if (do_help > 0)
7274 {
7275 any_help_event_p = 1;
7276 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7277 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7278 }
7279 else
7280 {
7281 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7282 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7283 }
7284 count++;
7285 }
7286
7287 *eventp = event;
7288 return count;
7289 }
7290
7291
7292 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7293 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7294 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7295
7296 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7297 int
7298 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
7299 XEvent *event;
7300 Display *display;
7301 {
7302 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7303 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7304
7305 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7306
7307 if (dpyinfo)
7308 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7309
7310 return finish;
7311 }
7312
7313
7314 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7315 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
7316 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7317
7318 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7319 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7320 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7321 C chars).
7322
7323 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7324
7325 static int
7326 XTread_socket (terminal, expected, hold_quit)
7327 struct terminal *terminal;
7328 int expected;
7329 struct input_event *hold_quit;
7330 {
7331 int count = 0;
7332 XEvent event;
7333 int event_found = 0;
7334 #if 0
7335 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7336 #endif
7337
7338 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7339 {
7340 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7341 return -1;
7342 }
7343
7344 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7345 BLOCK_INPUT;
7346
7347 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7348 input_signal_count++;
7349
7350 ++handling_signal;
7351
7352 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7353 /* Only check session manager input for the primary display. */
7354 if (terminal->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
7355 {
7356 struct input_event inev;
7357 BLOCK_INPUT;
7358 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
7359 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
7360 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
7361 {
7362 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
7363 count++;
7364 }
7365 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7366 }
7367 #endif
7368
7369 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7370 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7371 {
7372 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7373 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7374 }
7375
7376 #if 0 /* This loop is a noop now. */
7377 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
7378 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
7379 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
7380 {
7381 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
7382 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
7383 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
7384 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
7385 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
7386 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
7387 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
7388 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
7389 #endif
7390
7391 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
7392 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
7393 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
7394 for X connections. */
7395 #ifndef SIGIO
7396 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
7397 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
7398 {
7399 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
7400 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
7401 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7402 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
7403 }
7404 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
7405 #endif /* SIGIO */
7406 #endif
7407 }
7408 #endif
7409
7410 #ifndef USE_GTK
7411 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7412 {
7413 int finish;
7414
7415 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7416
7417 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7418 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7419 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7420 break;
7421 #endif
7422 event_found = 1;
7423
7424 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7425 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7426
7427 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7428 goto out;
7429 }
7430
7431 #else /* USE_GTK */
7432
7433 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7434 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7435 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7436 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7437
7438 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7439 from all displays. */
7440
7441 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7442 {
7443 current_count = count;
7444 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7445
7446 gtk_main_iteration ();
7447
7448 count = current_count;
7449 current_count = -1;
7450 current_hold_quit = 0;
7451
7452 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7453 break;
7454 }
7455 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7456
7457 out:;
7458
7459 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7460 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7461 if (! event_found)
7462 {
7463 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7464 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7465 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7466 x_noop_count++;
7467 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7468 {
7469 x_noop_count=0;
7470
7471 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7472 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7473
7474 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7475
7476 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7477 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7478 }
7479 }
7480
7481 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7482 raise it now. */
7483 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7484 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7485 {
7486 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7487 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7488 }
7489
7490 --handling_signal;
7491 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7492
7493 return count;
7494 }
7495
7496
7497
7498 \f
7499 /***********************************************************************
7500 Text Cursor
7501 ***********************************************************************/
7502
7503 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7504 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7505
7506 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7507 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7508 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7509
7510 static void
7511 x_clip_to_row (w, row, area, gc)
7512 struct window *w;
7513 struct glyph_row *row;
7514 int area;
7515 GC gc;
7516 {
7517 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7518 XRectangle clip_rect;
7519 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7520
7521 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7522
7523 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7524 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7525 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7526 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7527 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7528
7529 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7530 }
7531
7532
7533 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7534
7535 static void
7536 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
7537 struct window *w;
7538 struct glyph_row *row;
7539 {
7540 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7541 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7542 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7543 int x, y, wd, h;
7544 XGCValues xgcv;
7545 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7546 GC gc;
7547
7548 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7549 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7550 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7551 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7552 return;
7553
7554 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7555 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7556 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7557
7558 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7559 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7560 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7561 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7562 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7563 else
7564 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7565 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7566 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7567
7568 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7569 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7570 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7571 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7572 }
7573
7574
7575 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7576
7577 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7578 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7579 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7580 --gerd. */
7581
7582 static void
7583 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
7584 struct window *w;
7585 struct glyph_row *row;
7586 int width;
7587 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
7588 {
7589 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7590 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7591
7592 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7593 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7594 and mini-buffer. */
7595 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7596 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7597 return;
7598
7599 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7600 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7601 the bar might not be in the window. */
7602 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7603 {
7604 struct glyph_row *row;
7605 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7606 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7607 }
7608 else
7609 {
7610 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7611 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7612 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7613 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7614 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7615 XGCValues xgcv;
7616
7617 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7618 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7619 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7620 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7621 that the glyph is legible. */
7622 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7623 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7624 else
7625 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7626 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7627
7628 if (gc)
7629 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7630 else
7631 {
7632 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7633 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7634 }
7635
7636 if (width < 0)
7637 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7638 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7639
7640 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7641 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7642
7643 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7644 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7645 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7646 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7647 width, row->height);
7648 else
7649 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7650 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7651 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7652 row->height - width),
7653 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
7654 width);
7655
7656 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7657 }
7658 }
7659
7660
7661 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7662
7663 static void
7664 x_define_frame_cursor (f, cursor)
7665 struct frame *f;
7666 Cursor cursor;
7667 {
7668 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7669 }
7670
7671
7672 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7673
7674 static void
7675 x_clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, height)
7676 struct frame *f;
7677 int x, y, width, height;
7678 {
7679 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7680 x, y, width, height, False);
7681 }
7682
7683
7684 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7685
7686 static void
7687 x_draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y, cursor_type, cursor_width, on_p, active_p)
7688 struct window *w;
7689 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
7690 int x, y;
7691 int cursor_type, cursor_width;
7692 int on_p, active_p;
7693 {
7694 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7695
7696 if (on_p)
7697 {
7698 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7699 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7700
7701 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7702 && w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7703 {
7704 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7705 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, 0);
7706 }
7707 else
7708 switch (cursor_type)
7709 {
7710 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7711 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7712 break;
7713
7714 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7715 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7716 break;
7717
7718 case BAR_CURSOR:
7719 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7720 break;
7721
7722 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7723 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7724 break;
7725
7726 case NO_CURSOR:
7727 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7728 break;
7729
7730 default:
7731 abort ();
7732 }
7733
7734 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7735 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7736 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7737 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7738 #endif
7739 }
7740
7741 #ifndef XFlush
7742 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7743 #endif
7744 }
7745
7746 \f
7747 /* Icons. */
7748
7749 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7750
7751 int
7752 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
7753 struct frame *f;
7754 Lisp_Object file;
7755 {
7756 int bitmap_id;
7757
7758 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7759 return 1;
7760
7761 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7762 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7763 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7764 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7765
7766 if (STRINGP (file))
7767 {
7768 #ifdef USE_GTK
7769 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7770 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7771 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7772 return 0;
7773 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7774 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7775 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7776 }
7777 else
7778 {
7779 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7780 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7781 {
7782 int rc = -1;
7783
7784 #if defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7785 #ifdef USE_GTK
7786 if (xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7787 return 0;
7788 #else
7789 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7790 if (rc != -1)
7791 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7792 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7793 #endif /* defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS) */
7794
7795 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7796 if (rc == -1)
7797 {
7798 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_xbm_bits,
7799 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7800 if (rc == -1)
7801 return 1;
7802
7803 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7804 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7805 }
7806 }
7807
7808 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7809 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7810 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7811 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7812 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7813
7814 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7815 }
7816
7817 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7818 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7819
7820 return 0;
7821 }
7822
7823
7824 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7825 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7826
7827 int
7828 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
7829 struct frame *f;
7830 char *icon_name;
7831 {
7832 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7833 return 1;
7834
7835 {
7836 XTextProperty text;
7837 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7838 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7839 text.format = 8;
7840 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7841 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7842 }
7843
7844 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7845 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7846 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7847 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7848
7849 return 0;
7850 }
7851 \f
7852 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7853
7854 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7855 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7856
7857 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7858 be called from a signal handler.
7859 */
7860
7861 struct x_error_message_stack {
7862 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7863 Display *dpy;
7864 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7865 };
7866 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7867
7868 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7869 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7870 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7871
7872 static void
7873 x_error_catcher (display, error)
7874 Display *display;
7875 XErrorEvent *error;
7876 {
7877 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7878 x_error_message->string,
7879 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7880 }
7881
7882 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7883 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7884 operating on.
7885
7886 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7887 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7888 stored in *x_error_message.
7889
7890 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7891 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7892
7893 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7894
7895 void x_check_errors ();
7896
7897 void
7898 x_catch_errors (dpy)
7899 Display *dpy;
7900 {
7901 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7902
7903 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7904 XSync (dpy, False);
7905
7906 data->dpy = dpy;
7907 data->string[0] = 0;
7908 data->prev = x_error_message;
7909 x_error_message = data;
7910 }
7911
7912 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7913 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7914
7915 void
7916 x_uncatch_errors ()
7917 {
7918 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7919
7920 BLOCK_INPUT;
7921
7922 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7923 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7924 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7925 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7926
7927 tmp = x_error_message;
7928 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7929 xfree (tmp);
7930 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7931 }
7932
7933 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7934 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7935 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7936
7937 void
7938 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
7939 Display *dpy;
7940 char *format;
7941 {
7942 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7943 XSync (dpy, False);
7944
7945 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7946 {
7947 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7948 bcopy (x_error_message->string, string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7949 x_uncatch_errors ();
7950 error (format, string);
7951 }
7952 }
7953
7954 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7955 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7956
7957 int
7958 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
7959 Display *dpy;
7960 {
7961 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7962 XSync (dpy, False);
7963
7964 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7965 }
7966
7967 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7968
7969 void
7970 x_clear_errors (dpy)
7971 Display *dpy;
7972 {
7973 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7974 }
7975
7976 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7977 * idea. --lorentey */
7978 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7979
7980 void
7981 x_fully_uncatch_errors ()
7982 {
7983 while (x_error_message)
7984 x_uncatch_errors ();
7985 }
7986 #endif
7987
7988 /* Nonzero if x_catch_errors has been done and not yet canceled. */
7989
7990 int
7991 x_catching_errors ()
7992 {
7993 return x_error_message != 0;
7994 }
7995
7996 #if 0
7997 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7998 x_trace_wire ()
7999 {
8000 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
8001 }
8002 #endif /* ! 0 */
8003
8004 \f
8005 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
8006 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
8007 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
8008 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
8009 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
8010
8011 static SIGTYPE
8012 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
8013 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
8014 {
8015 #ifdef USG
8016 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
8017 must reestablish each time */
8018 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
8019 #endif /* USG */
8020 }
8021
8022 \f
8023 /************************************************************************
8024 Handling X errors
8025 ************************************************************************/
8026
8027 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
8028
8029 static char *error_msg;
8030
8031 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
8032 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
8033 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
8034
8035 static void
8036 x_fatal_error_signal ()
8037 {
8038 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
8039 exit (70);
8040 }
8041
8042 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
8043 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
8044
8045 static SIGTYPE
8046 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
8047 Display *dpy;
8048 char *error_message;
8049 {
8050 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
8051 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8052 int index = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
8053
8054 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
8055 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
8056 handling_signal = 0;
8057
8058 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
8059 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
8060 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
8061 the original message here. */
8062 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8063
8064 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
8065 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
8066
8067 if (dpyinfo)
8068 {
8069 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
8070 frame on it. */
8071 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
8072 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
8073 }
8074
8075 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
8076 that are on the dead display. */
8077 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8078 {
8079 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
8080 minibuf_frame
8081 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
8082 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
8083 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
8084 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
8085 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
8086 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
8087 }
8088
8089 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
8090 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
8091 for another frame that we need to delete. */
8092 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8093 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
8094 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
8095 {
8096 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
8097 trying to find a replacement. */
8098 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
8099 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
8100 }
8101
8102 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
8103 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
8104 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
8105
8106 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
8107 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
8108 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
8109
8110 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
8111 in the first call to make-frame-on-display.
8112
8113 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
8114 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
8115 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to circumvent it here. */
8116
8117 if (dpyinfo)
8118 {
8119 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8120 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
8121 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
8122 {
8123 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
8124 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
8125 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
8126 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
8127 }
8128 #endif
8129
8130 #ifdef USE_GTK
8131 /* Due to bugs in some Gtk+ versions, just exit here if this
8132 is the last display/terminal. */
8133 if (terminal_list->next_terminal == NULL)
8134 {
8135 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
8136 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
8137 exit (70);
8138 }
8139 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
8140 #endif
8141
8142 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
8143 dpyinfo->display = 0;
8144
8145 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
8146 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
8147 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
8148 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
8149 abort ();
8150
8151 {
8152 Lisp_Object tmp;
8153 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
8154 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
8155 }
8156 }
8157
8158 x_uncatch_errors ();
8159
8160 if (terminal_list == 0)
8161 {
8162 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
8163 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
8164 exit (70);
8165 }
8166
8167 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
8168 #ifdef SIGIO
8169 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
8170 #endif
8171 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
8172 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8173
8174 unbind_to (index, Qnil);
8175 clear_waiting_for_input ();
8176 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
8177 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
8178 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
8179 error ("%s", error_msg);
8180 }
8181
8182 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
8183 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
8184 static void x_error_quitter P_ ((Display *, XErrorEvent *));
8185
8186 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
8187 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
8188
8189 static int
8190 x_error_handler (display, error)
8191 Display *display;
8192 XErrorEvent *error;
8193 {
8194 if (x_error_message)
8195 x_error_catcher (display, error);
8196 else
8197 x_error_quitter (display, error);
8198 return 0;
8199 }
8200
8201 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
8202 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
8203 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
8204
8205 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
8206
8207 #if __GNUC__ >= 3 /* On GCC 3.0 we might get a warning. */
8208 #define NO_INLINE __attribute__((noinline))
8209 #else
8210 #define NO_INLINE
8211 #endif
8212
8213 /* Some versions of GNU/Linux define noinline in their headers. */
8214
8215 #ifdef noinline
8216 #undef noinline
8217 #endif
8218
8219 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
8220 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
8221
8222 static void NO_INLINE
8223 x_error_quitter (display, error)
8224 Display *display;
8225 XErrorEvent *error;
8226 {
8227 char buf[256], buf1[356];
8228
8229 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
8230 or colors that are not defined. */
8231
8232 if (error->error_code == BadName)
8233 return;
8234
8235 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
8236 original error handler. */
8237
8238 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
8239 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
8240 buf, error->request_code);
8241 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
8242 }
8243
8244
8245 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
8246 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
8247 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
8248
8249 static int
8250 x_io_error_quitter (display)
8251 Display *display;
8252 {
8253 char buf[256];
8254
8255 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
8256 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
8257 return 0;
8258 }
8259 \f
8260 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
8261
8262 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
8263 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
8264 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
8265 The return value shows which font we chose. */
8266
8267 Lisp_Object
8268 x_new_font (f, fontname)
8269 struct frame *f;
8270 register char *fontname;
8271 {
8272 struct font_info *fontp
8273 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, fontname);
8274
8275 if (!fontp)
8276 return Qnil;
8277
8278 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font))
8279 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
8280 do. */
8281 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
8282
8283 FRAME_FONT (f) = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
8284 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = fontp->baseline_offset;
8285 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = -1;
8286
8287 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = fontp->average_width;
8288 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = fontp->space_width;
8289 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
8290
8291 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
8292
8293 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
8294 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
8295 {
8296 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8297 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
8298 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
8299 }
8300 else
8301 {
8302 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8303 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
8304 }
8305
8306 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
8307 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
8308 {
8309 Font fid;
8310
8311 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
8312 if (enable_font_backend)
8313 fid = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->font->fid;
8314 else
8315 #endif
8316 fid = FRAME_FONT (f)->fid;
8317 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc, fid);
8318 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc, fid);
8319 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc, fid);
8320
8321 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
8322 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
8323 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
8324 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8325 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
8326 }
8327
8328 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
8329 }
8330
8331 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default fontset,
8332 and return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a
8333 wildcard pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits
8334 the pattern. FONTSETNAME may be a font name for ASCII characters;
8335 in that case, we create a fontset from that font name.
8336
8337 The return value shows which fontset we chose.
8338 If FONTSETNAME specifies the default fontset, return Qt.
8339 If an ASCII font in the specified fontset can't be loaded, return
8340 Qnil. */
8341
8342 Lisp_Object
8343 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
8344 struct frame *f;
8345 Lisp_Object fontsetname;
8346 {
8347 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (fontsetname, 0);
8348 Lisp_Object result;
8349
8350 if (fontset > 0 && f->output_data.x->fontset == fontset)
8351 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
8352 to do. */
8353 return fontset_name (fontset);
8354 else if (fontset == 0)
8355 /* The default fontset can't be the default font. */
8356 return Qt;
8357
8358 if (fontset > 0)
8359 result = x_new_font (f, (SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset))));
8360 else
8361 result = x_new_font (f, SDATA (fontsetname));
8362
8363 if (!STRINGP (result))
8364 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
8365 return Qnil;
8366
8367 if (fontset < 0)
8368 fontset = new_fontset_from_font_name (result);
8369
8370 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
8371 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
8372
8373 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8374 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
8375 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
8376 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
8377 #endif
8378
8379 return fontset_name (fontset);
8380 }
8381
8382 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
8383 Lisp_Object
8384 x_new_fontset2 (f, fontset, font_object)
8385 struct frame *f;
8386 int fontset;
8387 Lisp_Object font_object;
8388 {
8389 struct font *font = XSAVE_VALUE (font_object)->pointer;
8390
8391 if (FRAME_FONT_OBJECT (f) == font)
8392 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
8393 do. */
8394 return fontset_name (fontset);
8395
8396 BLOCK_INPUT;
8397
8398 FRAME_FONT_OBJECT (f) = font;
8399 FRAME_FONT (f) = font->font.font;
8400 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->font.baseline_offset;
8401 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
8402
8403 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->font.average_width;
8404 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->font.space_width;
8405 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = font->font.height;
8406
8407 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
8408
8409 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
8410 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
8411 {
8412 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8413 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
8414 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid - 1) / wid;
8415 }
8416 else
8417 {
8418 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8419 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
8420 }
8421
8422 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
8423 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
8424 {
8425 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
8426 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
8427 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
8428 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8429 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
8430 }
8431
8432 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8433 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
8434 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
8435 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
8436 #endif
8437
8438 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8439
8440 return fontset_name (fontset);
8441 }
8442 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
8443
8444 \f
8445 /***********************************************************************
8446 X Input Methods
8447 ***********************************************************************/
8448
8449 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8450
8451 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8452
8453 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
8454 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
8455 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
8456
8457 static void
8458 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
8459 XIM xim;
8460 XPointer client_data;
8461 XPointer call_data;
8462 {
8463 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
8464 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8465
8466 BLOCK_INPUT;
8467
8468 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
8469 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8470 {
8471 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8472 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
8473 {
8474 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
8475 xic_free_xfontset (f);
8476 }
8477 }
8478
8479 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8480 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8481 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8482 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8483 }
8484
8485 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8486
8487 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8488 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8489 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
8490 #endif
8491
8492 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8493 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8494
8495 static void
8496 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8497 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8498 char *resource_name;
8499 {
8500 XIM xim;
8501
8502 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8503 if (use_xim)
8504 {
8505 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8506 EMACS_CLASS);
8507 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8508
8509 if (xim)
8510 {
8511 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8512 XIMCallback destroy;
8513 #endif
8514
8515 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8516 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8517
8518 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8519 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8520 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8521 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8522 #endif
8523 }
8524 }
8525
8526 else
8527 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8528 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8529 }
8530
8531
8532 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8533
8534 struct xim_inst_t
8535 {
8536 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8537 char *resource_name;
8538 };
8539
8540 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8541 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8542 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8543 when the callback was registered. */
8544
8545 static void
8546 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
8547 Display *display;
8548 XPointer client_data;
8549 XPointer call_data;
8550 {
8551 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8552 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8553
8554 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8555 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8556 return;
8557
8558 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8559
8560 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8561 as they have no XIC. */
8562 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8563 {
8564 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8565
8566 BLOCK_INPUT;
8567 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8568 {
8569 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8570
8571 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8572 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8573 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8574 {
8575 create_frame_xic (f);
8576 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8577 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8578 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8579 {
8580 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8581 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8582 }
8583 }
8584 }
8585
8586 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8587 }
8588 }
8589
8590 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8591
8592
8593 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8594 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8595 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8596 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8597
8598 static void
8599 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8600 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8601 char *resource_name;
8602 {
8603 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8604 if (use_xim)
8605 {
8606 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8607 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8608 int len;
8609
8610 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8611 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8612 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8613 len = strlen (resource_name);
8614 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8615 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
8616 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8617 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
8618 xim_instantiate_callback,
8619 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8620 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8621 least, hence the configure test. */
8622 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8623 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8624 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8625 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8626 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8627
8628 }
8629 else
8630 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8631 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8632 }
8633
8634
8635 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8636
8637 static void
8638 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
8639 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8640 {
8641 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8642 if (use_xim)
8643 {
8644 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8645 if (dpyinfo->display)
8646 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8647 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
8648 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8649 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8650 if (dpyinfo->display)
8651 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8652 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8653 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8654 }
8655 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8656 }
8657
8658 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8659
8660
8661 \f
8662 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8663 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8664
8665 void
8666 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
8667 struct frame *f;
8668 {
8669 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8670
8671 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8672 is already for the top-left corner. */
8673 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8674 return;
8675
8676 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8677 position that fits on the screen. */
8678 if (flags & XNegative)
8679 f->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
8680 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos);
8681
8682 {
8683 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8684
8685 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8686 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8687 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8688
8689 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8690 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8691 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8692 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8693 is right, though.
8694
8695 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8696 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8697
8698 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8699 #endif
8700
8701 if (flags & YNegative)
8702 f->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - height + f->top_pos);
8703 }
8704
8705 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8706 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8707 so the flags should correspond. */
8708 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8709 }
8710
8711 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8712 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8713 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8714 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8715 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8716
8717 void
8718 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
8719 struct frame *f;
8720 register int xoff, yoff;
8721 int change_gravity;
8722 {
8723 int modified_top, modified_left;
8724
8725 if (change_gravity > 0)
8726 {
8727 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8728 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8729
8730 f->top_pos = yoff;
8731 f->left_pos = xoff;
8732 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8733 if (xoff < 0)
8734 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8735 if (yoff < 0)
8736 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8737 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8738 }
8739 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8740
8741 BLOCK_INPUT;
8742 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8743
8744 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8745 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8746
8747 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8748 {
8749 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8750 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8751 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8752 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8753 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8754 }
8755
8756 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8757 modified_left, modified_top);
8758
8759 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8760 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8761 ? 1 : 0);
8762
8763 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8764 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8765 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8766 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8767 of the frame.
8768
8769 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8770 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8771 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8772
8773 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8774 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8775 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8776 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8777 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8778 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8779
8780 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8781 }
8782
8783 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8784 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8785 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8786 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8787 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8788
8789 static int
8790 wm_supports (f, atomname)
8791 struct frame *f;
8792 const char *atomname;
8793 {
8794 Atom actual_type;
8795 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8796 int i, rc, actual_format;
8797 Atom prop_atom;
8798 Window wmcheck_window;
8799 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8800 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8801 long max_len = 65536;
8802 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8803 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8804 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8805 Atom want_atom;
8806
8807 BLOCK_INPUT;
8808
8809 prop_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", False);
8810
8811 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8812 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8813 prop_atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8814 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8815 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8816
8817 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8818 {
8819 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8820 x_uncatch_errors ();
8821 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8822 return 0;
8823 }
8824
8825 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8826 XFree (tmp_data);
8827
8828 /* Check if window exists. */
8829 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8830 x_sync (f);
8831 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8832 {
8833 x_uncatch_errors ();
8834 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8835 return 0;
8836 }
8837
8838 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8839 {
8840 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8841 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8842 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8843 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8844 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8845 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8846
8847 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8848 prop_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, "_NET_SUPPORTED", False);
8849 tmp_data = NULL;
8850 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8851 prop_atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8852 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8853 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8854
8855 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8856 {
8857 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8858 x_uncatch_errors ();
8859 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8860 return 0;
8861 }
8862
8863 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8864 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8865 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8866 }
8867
8868 rc = 0;
8869 want_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, atomname, False);
8870
8871 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8872 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8873
8874 x_uncatch_errors ();
8875 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8876
8877 return rc;
8878 }
8879
8880 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8881
8882 static int
8883 do_ewmh_fullscreen (f)
8884 struct frame *f;
8885 {
8886 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, "_NET_WM_STATE");
8887
8888 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8889 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8890 if (!have_net_atom)
8891 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN");
8892
8893 if (have_net_atom)
8894 {
8895 Lisp_Object frame;
8896 const char *atom = "_NET_WM_STATE";
8897 const char *fs = "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN";
8898 const char *fw = "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ";
8899 const char *fh = "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT";
8900 const char *what = NULL;
8901
8902 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8903
8904 /* If there are _NET_ atoms we assume we have extended window manager
8905 hints. */
8906 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8907 {
8908 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8909 what = fs;
8910 break;
8911 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8912 what = fw;
8913 break;
8914 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8915 what = fh;
8916 break;
8917 }
8918
8919 if (what != NULL && !wm_supports (f, what)) return 0;
8920
8921
8922 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8923 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8924 make_number (32),
8925 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8926 Fcons
8927 (make_unibyte_string (fs,
8928 strlen (fs)),
8929 Qnil)));
8930 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8931 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8932 make_number (32),
8933 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8934 Fcons
8935 (make_unibyte_string (fh,
8936 strlen (fh)),
8937 Qnil)));
8938 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8939 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8940 make_number (32),
8941 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8942 Fcons
8943 (make_unibyte_string (fw,
8944 strlen (fw)),
8945 Qnil)));
8946 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8947 if (what != NULL)
8948 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8949 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8950 make_number (32),
8951 Fcons (make_number (1), /* Add */
8952 Fcons
8953 (make_unibyte_string (what,
8954 strlen (what)),
8955 Qnil)));
8956 }
8957
8958 return have_net_atom;
8959 }
8960
8961 static void
8962 XTfullscreen_hook (f)
8963 FRAME_PTR f;
8964 {
8965 if (f->async_visible)
8966 {
8967 BLOCK_INPUT;
8968 do_ewmh_fullscreen (f);
8969 x_sync (f);
8970 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8971 }
8972 }
8973
8974
8975 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8976 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8977 static void
8978 x_check_fullscreen (f)
8979 struct frame *f;
8980 {
8981 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8982 {
8983 int width, height, ign;
8984
8985 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8986 return;
8987
8988 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
8989
8990 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
8991
8992 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
8993 when setting WM manager hints.
8994 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
8995 x_check_expected_move. */
8996 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8997 {
8998 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8999 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
9000 cancel_mouse_face (f);
9001
9002 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
9003 f->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
9004 }
9005 }
9006 }
9007
9008 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
9009 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
9010 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
9011 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
9012 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
9013 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
9014 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
9015
9016 static void
9017 x_check_expected_move (f, expected_left, expected_top)
9018 struct frame *f;
9019 int expected_left;
9020 int expected_top;
9021 {
9022 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
9023
9024 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
9025 window manager window around the frame. */
9026
9027 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
9028
9029 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
9030 {
9031 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
9032
9033 int adjusted_left;
9034 int adjusted_top;
9035
9036 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
9037 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
9038 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
9039
9040 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
9041
9042 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
9043 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
9044
9045 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9046 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
9047
9048 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
9049 }
9050 else
9051 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
9052 frame's position. */
9053
9054 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
9055 }
9056
9057
9058 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
9059 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
9060 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
9061 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
9062 of an exact comparison. */
9063
9064 static void
9065 x_sync_with_move (f, left, top, fuzzy)
9066 struct frame *f;
9067 int left, top, fuzzy;
9068 {
9069 int count = 0;
9070
9071 while (count++ < 50)
9072 {
9073 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
9074
9075 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
9076 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
9077 loop. */
9078
9079 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9080 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
9081
9082 if (fuzzy)
9083 {
9084 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
9085 pixels. */
9086
9087 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
9088 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
9089 return;
9090 }
9091 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
9092 return;
9093 }
9094
9095 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
9096 will then return up-to-date position info. */
9097
9098 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
9099 }
9100
9101
9102 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
9103 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
9104 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
9105 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
9106
9107 static void
9108 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
9109 struct frame *f;
9110 int change_gravity;
9111 int cols, rows;
9112 {
9113 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
9114
9115 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
9116 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
9117 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
9118 ? 0
9119 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0
9120 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f)
9121 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f)));
9122
9123 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
9124
9125 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
9126 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
9127
9128 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
9129 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
9130
9131 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9132 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9133 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
9134
9135 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
9136 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
9137 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
9138 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
9139
9140 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
9141 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
9142 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
9143 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
9144 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
9145
9146 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
9147 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
9148 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
9149 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
9150 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
9151
9152 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
9153 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
9154 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
9155 we have to make sure to do it here. */
9156 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
9157
9158 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9159 }
9160
9161
9162 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
9163 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
9164 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
9165 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
9166
9167 void
9168 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
9169 struct frame *f;
9170 int change_gravity;
9171 int cols, rows;
9172 {
9173 BLOCK_INPUT;
9174
9175 #ifdef USE_GTK
9176 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
9177 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
9178 else
9179 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
9180 #elif USE_X_TOOLKIT
9181
9182 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
9183 {
9184 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
9185 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
9186 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
9187 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
9188 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
9189 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
9190 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
9191 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
9192 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
9193 }
9194 else
9195 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
9196
9197 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9198
9199 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
9200
9201 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9202
9203 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
9204 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
9205
9206 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
9207 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
9208 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
9209 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
9210 cancel_mouse_face (f);
9211
9212 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9213 }
9214 \f
9215 /* Mouse warping. */
9216
9217 void
9218 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
9219 struct frame *f;
9220 int x, y;
9221 {
9222 int pix_x, pix_y;
9223
9224 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
9225 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
9226
9227 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
9228 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9229
9230 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
9231 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9232
9233 BLOCK_INPUT;
9234
9235 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9236 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
9237 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9238 }
9239
9240 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
9241
9242 void
9243 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
9244 struct frame *f;
9245 int pix_x, pix_y;
9246 {
9247 BLOCK_INPUT;
9248
9249 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9250 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
9251 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9252 }
9253 \f
9254 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
9255
9256 void
9257 x_focus_on_frame (f)
9258 struct frame *f;
9259 {
9260 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
9261 x_raise_frame (f);
9262 #endif
9263 #if 0
9264 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
9265 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
9266 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
9267 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9268 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
9269 #endif /* ! 0 */
9270 }
9271
9272 void
9273 x_unfocus_frame (f)
9274 struct frame *f;
9275 {
9276 #if 0
9277 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
9278 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
9279 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
9280 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
9281 #endif /* ! 0 */
9282 }
9283
9284 /* Raise frame F. */
9285
9286 void
9287 x_raise_frame (f)
9288 struct frame *f;
9289 {
9290 BLOCK_INPUT;
9291 if (f->async_visible)
9292 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
9293
9294 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9295 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9296 }
9297
9298 /* Lower frame F. */
9299
9300 void
9301 x_lower_frame (f)
9302 struct frame *f;
9303 {
9304 if (f->async_visible)
9305 {
9306 BLOCK_INPUT;
9307 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
9308 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9309 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9310 }
9311 }
9312
9313 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
9314
9315 void
9316 x_ewmh_activate_frame (f)
9317 FRAME_PTR f;
9318 {
9319 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
9320 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
9321
9322 const char *atom = "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW";
9323 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, atom))
9324 {
9325 Lisp_Object frame;
9326 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9327 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
9328 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
9329 make_number (32),
9330 Fcons (make_number (1),
9331 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
9332 Qnil)));
9333 }
9334 }
9335
9336 static void
9337 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
9338 FRAME_PTR f;
9339 int raise_flag;
9340 {
9341 if (raise_flag)
9342 x_raise_frame (f);
9343 else
9344 x_lower_frame (f);
9345 }
9346 \f
9347 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9348
9349 void
9350 xembed_set_info (f, flags)
9351 struct frame *f;
9352 enum xembed_info flags;
9353 {
9354 Atom atom;
9355 unsigned long data[2];
9356
9357 atom = XInternAtom (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), "_XEMBED_INFO", False);
9358
9359 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
9360 data[1] = flags;
9361
9362 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), atom, atom,
9363 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
9364 }
9365
9366 void
9367 xembed_send_message (f, time, message, detail, data1, data2)
9368 struct frame *f;
9369 Time time;
9370 enum xembed_message message;
9371 long detail;
9372 long data1;
9373 long data2;
9374 {
9375 XEvent event;
9376
9377 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9378 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9379 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9380 event.xclient.format = 32;
9381 event.xclient.data.l[0] = time;
9382 event.xclient.data.l[1] = message;
9383 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9384 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9385 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9386
9387 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9388 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9389 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9390 }
9391 \f
9392 /* Change of visibility. */
9393
9394 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9395 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9396 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9397 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9398 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9399 finishes with it. */
9400
9401 void
9402 x_make_frame_visible (f)
9403 struct frame *f;
9404 {
9405 Lisp_Object type;
9406 int original_top, original_left;
9407 int retry_count = 2;
9408
9409 retry:
9410
9411 BLOCK_INPUT;
9412
9413 type = x_icon_type (f);
9414 if (!NILP (type))
9415 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9416
9417 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9418 {
9419 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9420 call x_set_offset a second time
9421 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9422 before the window gets really visible. */
9423 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9424 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9425 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9426 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9427
9428 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9429
9430 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9431 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9432 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9433 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9434 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9435 else
9436 {
9437 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9438 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9439 }
9440 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9441 #ifdef USE_GTK
9442 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9443 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9444 #else
9445 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9446 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9447 else
9448 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9449 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9450 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9451 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
9452 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
9453 to come back ok without this. */
9454 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
9455 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9456 #endif
9457 }
9458
9459 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9460
9461 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9462 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9463 so that incoming events are handled. */
9464 {
9465 Lisp_Object frame;
9466 int count;
9467 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9468 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9469 will set it when they are handled. */
9470 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9471
9472 original_left = f->left_pos;
9473 original_top = f->top_pos;
9474
9475 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9476 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9477
9478 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9479
9480 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9481 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9482 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9483 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9484
9485 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9486 because the window manager may choose the position
9487 and we don't want to override it. */
9488
9489 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9490 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9491 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9492 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9493 && previously_visible)
9494 {
9495 Drawable rootw;
9496 int x, y;
9497 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9498
9499 BLOCK_INPUT;
9500
9501 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9502 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9503 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9504 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9505 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9506 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9507 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9508 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9509 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9510
9511 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9512 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9513 original_left, original_top);
9514
9515 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9516 }
9517
9518 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9519
9520 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9521 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9522 MapNotify at all.. */
9523 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9524 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9525 {
9526 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9527 x_sync (f);
9528
9529 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9530 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9531 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9532 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9533 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9534 probably a bug. */
9535 if (input_polling_used ())
9536 {
9537 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9538 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9539 handler reset it. */
9540 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
9541 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9542 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9543 poll_for_input_1 ();
9544 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9545 }
9546
9547 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9548 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9549 }
9550
9551 /* 2000-09-28: In
9552
9553 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9554 (iconify-frame f)
9555 (raise-frame f))
9556
9557 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9558 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9559 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9560 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9561
9562 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
9563 goto retry;
9564 }
9565 }
9566
9567 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9568
9569 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9570
9571 void
9572 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
9573 struct frame *f;
9574 {
9575 Window window;
9576
9577 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9578 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9579
9580 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9581 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9582 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9583
9584 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
9585 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
9586 return;
9587 #endif
9588
9589 BLOCK_INPUT;
9590
9591 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9592 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9593 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9594 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9595 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9596 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9597
9598 #ifdef USE_GTK
9599 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9600 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9601 else
9602 #else
9603 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9604 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9605 else
9606 #endif
9607 {
9608
9609 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9610 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9611 {
9612 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9613 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9614 }
9615 }
9616
9617 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9618 just by the event that we get from the server.
9619 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9620 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9621 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9622 f->visible = 0;
9623 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9624 f->async_visible = 0;
9625 f->async_iconified = 0;
9626
9627 x_sync (f);
9628
9629 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9630 }
9631
9632 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9633
9634 void
9635 x_iconify_frame (f)
9636 struct frame *f;
9637 {
9638 int result;
9639 Lisp_Object type;
9640
9641 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9642 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9643 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9644
9645 if (f->async_iconified)
9646 return;
9647
9648 BLOCK_INPUT;
9649
9650 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9651
9652 type = x_icon_type (f);
9653 if (!NILP (type))
9654 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9655
9656 #ifdef USE_GTK
9657 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9658 {
9659 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9660 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9661
9662 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9663 f->iconified = 1;
9664 f->visible = 1;
9665 f->async_iconified = 1;
9666 f->async_visible = 0;
9667 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9668 return;
9669 }
9670 #endif
9671
9672 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9673
9674 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9675 {
9676 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9677 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9678 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9679 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9680 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9681 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9682 so we have to record it here. */
9683 f->iconified = 1;
9684 f->visible = 1;
9685 f->async_iconified = 1;
9686 f->async_visible = 0;
9687 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9688 return;
9689 }
9690
9691 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9692 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9693 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9694 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9695
9696 if (!result)
9697 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9698
9699 f->async_iconified = 1;
9700 f->async_visible = 0;
9701
9702
9703 BLOCK_INPUT;
9704 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9705 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9706 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9707
9708 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9709 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9710 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9711 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9712 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9713 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9714
9715 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9716 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9717
9718 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9719 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9720 {
9721 XEvent message;
9722
9723 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9724 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9725 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9726 message.xclient.format = 32;
9727 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9728
9729 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9730 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9731 False,
9732 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9733 &message))
9734 {
9735 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9736 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9737 }
9738 }
9739
9740 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9741 IconicState. */
9742 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9743
9744 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9745 {
9746 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9747 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9748 }
9749
9750 f->async_iconified = 1;
9751 f->async_visible = 0;
9752
9753 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9754 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9755 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9756 }
9757
9758 \f
9759 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9760
9761 void
9762 x_free_frame_resources (f)
9763 struct frame *f;
9764 {
9765 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9766 Lisp_Object bar;
9767 struct scroll_bar *b;
9768
9769 BLOCK_INPUT;
9770
9771 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9772 commands to the X server. */
9773 if (dpyinfo->display)
9774 {
9775 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
9776 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9777 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9778 face. */
9779 if (enable_font_backend
9780 && FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9781 free_frame_faces (f);
9782 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
9783
9784 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9785 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9786
9787 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9788 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9789 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9790 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9791 toolkit scroll bars. */
9792 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9793 {
9794 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9795 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9796 }
9797 #endif
9798
9799 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9800 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9801 free_frame_xic (f);
9802 #endif
9803
9804 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9805 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9806 {
9807 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9808 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9809 }
9810 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9811 we are using a toolkit. */
9812 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9813 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9814
9815 free_frame_menubar (f);
9816 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9817
9818 #ifdef USE_GTK
9819 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
9820 frames. We must check and free both types. */
9821 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9822 {
9823 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9824 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
9825 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
9826 }
9827 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9828
9829 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9830 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9831 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9832
9833 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9834 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9835 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9836 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9837 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9838 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9839
9840 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9841 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9842 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9843 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9844 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9845 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9846 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9847 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9848 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9849 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9850 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9851 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9852 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9853 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9854 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9855
9856 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9857 free_frame_faces (f);
9858
9859 x_free_gcs (f);
9860 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9861 }
9862
9863 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
9864 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9865
9866 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9867 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9868
9869 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9870 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9871 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9872 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9873 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9874 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9875
9876 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9877 {
9878 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9879 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9880 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9881 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9882 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9883 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9884 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9885 }
9886
9887 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9888 }
9889
9890
9891 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9892
9893 void
9894 x_destroy_window (f)
9895 struct frame *f;
9896 {
9897 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9898
9899 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9900 commands to the X server. */
9901 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9902 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9903
9904 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9905 }
9906
9907 \f
9908 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9909
9910 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9911 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9912 that the window now has.
9913 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9914 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9915 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9916
9917 #ifndef USE_GTK
9918 void
9919 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9920 struct frame *f;
9921 long flags;
9922 int user_position;
9923 {
9924 XSizeHints size_hints;
9925
9926 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9927 Arg al[2];
9928 int ac = 0;
9929 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
9930 #endif
9931
9932 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9933
9934 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9935 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9936
9937 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9938 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9939
9940 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9941 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
9942 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
9943 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
9944 size_hints.height = widget_height;
9945 size_hints.width = widget_width;
9946 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9947 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9948 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9949 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9950
9951 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9952 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9953 size_hints.max_width
9954 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9955 size_hints.max_height
9956 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9957
9958 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9959
9960 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9961 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9962 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9963 {
9964 int base_width, base_height;
9965 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9966
9967 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9968 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9969
9970 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9971
9972 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9973 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9974 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9975 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9976 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9977
9978 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9979 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9980 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9981
9982 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9983 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9984 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
9985 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9986 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9987 }
9988
9989 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9990 if (flags)
9991 {
9992 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9993 goto no_read;
9994 }
9995 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9996
9997 {
9998 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9999 long supplied_return;
10000 int value;
10001
10002 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
10003 &supplied_return);
10004
10005 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10006 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
10007 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
10008 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
10009 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
10010 #endif
10011
10012 if (flags)
10013 size_hints.flags |= flags;
10014 else
10015 {
10016 if (value == 0)
10017 hints.flags = 0;
10018 if (hints.flags & PSize)
10019 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
10020 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
10021 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
10022 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
10023 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
10024 if (hints.flags & USSize)
10025 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
10026 }
10027 }
10028
10029 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10030 no_read:
10031 #endif
10032
10033 #ifdef PWinGravity
10034 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
10035 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
10036
10037 if (user_position)
10038 {
10039 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
10040 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
10041 }
10042 #endif /* PWinGravity */
10043
10044 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
10045 }
10046 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
10047
10048 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
10049
10050 void
10051 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
10052 struct frame *f;
10053 int state;
10054 {
10055 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10056 Arg al[1];
10057
10058 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
10059 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
10060 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10061 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
10062
10063 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
10064 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
10065
10066 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
10067 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10068 }
10069
10070 void
10071 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
10072 struct frame *f;
10073 int pixmap_id;
10074 {
10075 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
10076
10077 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10078 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
10079 #endif
10080
10081 if (pixmap_id > 0)
10082 {
10083 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
10084 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
10085 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
10086 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
10087 }
10088 else
10089 {
10090 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
10091 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
10092 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
10093 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
10094 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
10095 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
10096 best to explicitly give up. */
10097 #if 0
10098 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
10099 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = None;
10100 #else
10101 return;
10102 #endif
10103 }
10104
10105
10106 #ifdef USE_GTK
10107 {
10108 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
10109 return;
10110 }
10111
10112 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
10113
10114 {
10115 Arg al[1];
10116 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
10117 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
10118 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
10119 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
10120 }
10121
10122 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
10123
10124 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
10125 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
10126
10127 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
10128 }
10129
10130 void
10131 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
10132 struct frame *f;
10133 int icon_x, icon_y;
10134 {
10135 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
10136
10137 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
10138 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
10139 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
10140
10141 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
10142 }
10143
10144 \f
10145 /***********************************************************************
10146 Fonts
10147 ***********************************************************************/
10148
10149 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
10150
10151 struct font_info *
10152 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
10153 FRAME_PTR f;
10154 int font_idx;
10155 {
10156 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
10157 }
10158
10159
10160 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
10161
10162 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
10163 to be listed.
10164
10165 SIZE < 0 means include auto scaled fonts.
10166
10167 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
10168 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
10169 on how many fonts to match. */
10170
10171 Lisp_Object
10172 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
10173 struct frame *f;
10174 Lisp_Object pattern;
10175 int size;
10176 int maxnames;
10177 {
10178 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
10179 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
10180 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
10181 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
10182 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10183 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
10184 int allow_auto_scaled_font = 0;
10185
10186 if (size < 0)
10187 {
10188 allow_auto_scaled_font = 1;
10189 size = 0;
10190 }
10191
10192 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
10193 if (NILP (patterns))
10194 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
10195
10196 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
10197 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
10198 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
10199
10200 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
10201 {
10202 int num_fonts;
10203 char **names = NULL;
10204
10205 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
10206 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
10207 The cache is an alist of the form:
10208 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
10209 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
10210 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
10211 allow_auto_scaled_font ? Qt : Qnil);
10212 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
10213 if (!NILP (list))
10214 {
10215 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
10216 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
10217 goto label_cached;
10218 }
10219
10220 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
10221
10222 BLOCK_INPUT;
10223 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10224
10225 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
10226 {
10227 XFontStruct *font;
10228 unsigned long value;
10229
10230 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, SDATA (pattern));
10231 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
10232 {
10233 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
10234 server. Let's just ignore it. */
10235 font = NULL;
10236 x_clear_errors (dpy);
10237 }
10238
10239 if (font
10240 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
10241 {
10242 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
10243 int len = strlen (name);
10244 char *tmp;
10245
10246 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
10247 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
10248 string. We must avoid such a name. */
10249 if (len == 0)
10250 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
10251 else
10252 {
10253 num_fonts = 1;
10254 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
10255 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
10256 simple var. */
10257 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
10258 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
10259 XFree (name);
10260 }
10261 }
10262 else
10263 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
10264
10265 if (font)
10266 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
10267 }
10268
10269 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
10270 {
10271 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
10272 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
10273 if (maxnames < 0)
10274 {
10275 int limit;
10276
10277 for (limit = 500;;)
10278 {
10279 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), limit, &num_fonts);
10280 if (num_fonts == limit)
10281 {
10282 BLOCK_INPUT;
10283 XFreeFontNames (names);
10284 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10285 limit *= 2;
10286 }
10287 else
10288 break;
10289 }
10290 }
10291 else
10292 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), max (maxnames, 10),
10293 &num_fonts);
10294
10295 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
10296 {
10297 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
10298 server. Let's just ignore it. */
10299 names = NULL;
10300 x_clear_errors (dpy);
10301 }
10302 }
10303
10304 x_uncatch_errors ();
10305 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10306
10307 if (names)
10308 {
10309 int i;
10310
10311 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
10312 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
10313 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
10314 {
10315 int width = 0;
10316 char *p = names[i];
10317 int average_width = -1, resx = 0, dashes = 0;
10318
10319 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
10320 14 dashes, the field value following 9th dash
10321 (RESOLUTION_X) is nonzero, and the field value
10322 following 12th dash (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a
10323 auto-scaled font which is usually too ugly to be used
10324 for editing. Let's ignore it. */
10325 while (*p)
10326 if (*p++ == '-')
10327 {
10328 dashes++;
10329 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
10330 width = atoi (p);
10331 else if (dashes == 9)
10332 resx = atoi (p);
10333 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
10334 average_width = atoi (p);
10335 }
10336
10337 if (allow_auto_scaled_font
10338 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0 || resx == 0)
10339 {
10340 tem = build_string (names[i]);
10341 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
10342 {
10343 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
10344 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
10345 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
10346 >= 0))
10347 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
10348 width of this font. */
10349 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
10350 else
10351 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
10352 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
10353 }
10354 }
10355 }
10356
10357 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
10358 {
10359 BLOCK_INPUT;
10360 XFreeFontNames (names);
10361 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10362 }
10363 }
10364
10365 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
10366 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
10367 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
10368
10369 label_cached:
10370 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
10371
10372 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
10373 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
10374 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
10375 {
10376 int found_size;
10377
10378 tem = XCAR (list);
10379
10380 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
10381 continue;
10382 if (!size)
10383 {
10384 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
10385 continue;
10386 }
10387
10388 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
10389 {
10390 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
10391 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
10392 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
10393
10394 BLOCK_INPUT;
10395 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10396 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
10397 SDATA (XCAR (tem)));
10398 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
10399 {
10400 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
10401 server. Let's just ignore it. */
10402 thisinfo = NULL;
10403 x_clear_errors (dpy);
10404 }
10405 x_uncatch_errors ();
10406 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10407
10408 if (thisinfo)
10409 {
10410 XSETCDR (tem,
10411 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
10412 ? make_number (0)
10413 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
10414 BLOCK_INPUT;
10415 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
10416 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10417 }
10418 else
10419 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
10420 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
10421 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
10422 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
10423 }
10424
10425 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
10426 if (found_size == size)
10427 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
10428 else if (found_size > 0)
10429 {
10430 if (NILP (second_best))
10431 second_best = tem;
10432 else if (found_size < size)
10433 {
10434 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
10435 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
10436 second_best = tem;
10437 }
10438 else
10439 {
10440 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
10441 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
10442 second_best = tem;
10443 }
10444 }
10445 }
10446 if (!NILP (newlist))
10447 break;
10448 else if (!NILP (second_best))
10449 {
10450 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
10451 break;
10452 }
10453 }
10454
10455 return newlist;
10456 }
10457
10458
10459 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
10460
10461 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
10462 font table. */
10463
10464 static void
10465 x_check_font (f, font)
10466 struct frame *f;
10467 XFontStruct *font;
10468 {
10469 int i;
10470 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10471
10472 xassert (font != NULL);
10473
10474 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
10475 if (enable_font_backend)
10476 /* Fixme: Perhaps we should check all cached fonts. */
10477 return;
10478 #endif
10479 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10480 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
10481 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
10482 break;
10483
10484 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
10485 }
10486
10487 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
10488
10489 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
10490 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
10491 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
10492 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
10493 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
10494
10495 static INLINE void
10496 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
10497 XFontStruct *font;
10498 int *w, *h;
10499 {
10500 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
10501 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
10502
10503 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
10504 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
10505 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
10506 if (*w <= 0)
10507 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
10508 }
10509
10510
10511 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
10512 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
10513 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
10514 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
10515 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
10516
10517 static int
10518 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
10519 struct frame *f;
10520 {
10521 int i;
10522 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10523 XFontStruct *font;
10524 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
10525 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
10526
10527 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
10528 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
10529
10530 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
10531 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
10532 {
10533 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
10534 int w, h;
10535
10536 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
10537 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
10538 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
10539
10540 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
10541 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
10542 }
10543
10544 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
10545 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
10546
10547 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
10548 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
10549 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
10550 }
10551
10552
10553 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
10554 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
10555 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
10556 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
10557
10558 struct font_info *
10559 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
10560 struct frame *f;
10561 register char *fontname;
10562 int size;
10563 {
10564 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10565 Lisp_Object font_names;
10566
10567 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
10568 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
10569 we already have by comparing names. */
10570 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
10571
10572 if (!NILP (font_names))
10573 {
10574 Lisp_Object tail;
10575 int i;
10576
10577 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10578 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
10579 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
10580 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
10581 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))
10582 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
10583 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))))
10584 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
10585 }
10586
10587 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
10588 {
10589 char *full_name;
10590 XFontStruct *font;
10591 struct font_info *fontp;
10592 unsigned long value;
10593 int i;
10594
10595 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
10596 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
10597 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
10598 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
10599 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
10600 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
10601 fontname = (char *) SDATA (XCAR (font_names));
10602
10603 BLOCK_INPUT;
10604 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10605 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
10606 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
10607 {
10608 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
10609 server. Let's just ignore it. */
10610 font = NULL;
10611 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10612 }
10613 x_uncatch_errors ();
10614 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10615 if (!font)
10616 return NULL;
10617
10618 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
10619 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
10620 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
10621 break;
10622
10623 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
10624 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
10625 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
10626 {
10627 int sz;
10628 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
10629 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
10630 dpyinfo->font_table
10631 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
10632 }
10633
10634 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
10635 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
10636 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
10637
10638 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
10639 BLOCK_INPUT;
10640 bzero (fontp, sizeof (*fontp));
10641 fontp->font = font;
10642 fontp->font_idx = i;
10643 fontp->charset = -1; /* fs_load_font sets it. */
10644 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
10645 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
10646
10647 if (font->min_bounds.width == font->max_bounds.width)
10648 {
10649 /* Fixed width font. */
10650 fontp->average_width = fontp->space_width = font->min_bounds.width;
10651 }
10652 else
10653 {
10654 XChar2b char2b;
10655 XCharStruct *pcm;
10656
10657 char2b.byte1 = 0x00, char2b.byte2 = 0x20;
10658 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0);
10659 if (pcm)
10660 fontp->space_width = pcm->width;
10661 else
10662 fontp->space_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
10663
10664 fontp->average_width
10665 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH, &value)
10666 ? (long) value / 10 : 0);
10667 if (fontp->average_width < 0)
10668 fontp->average_width = - fontp->average_width;
10669 if (fontp->average_width == 0)
10670 {
10671 if (pcm)
10672 {
10673 int width = pcm->width;
10674 for (char2b.byte2 = 33; char2b.byte2 <= 126; char2b.byte2++)
10675 if ((pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0)) != NULL)
10676 width += pcm->width;
10677 fontp->average_width = width / 95;
10678 }
10679 else
10680 fontp->average_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
10681 }
10682 }
10683
10684 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
10685 full_name = 0;
10686 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
10687 {
10688 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
10689 char *p = name;
10690 int dashes = 0;
10691
10692 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
10693 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
10694 so don't use it.
10695 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
10696 stored in them. */
10697 while (*p)
10698 {
10699 if (*p == '-')
10700 dashes++;
10701 p++;
10702 }
10703
10704 if (dashes >= 13)
10705 {
10706 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
10707 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
10708 }
10709
10710 XFree (name);
10711 }
10712
10713 if (full_name != 0)
10714 fontp->full_name = full_name;
10715 else
10716 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
10717
10718 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
10719 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
10720
10721 if (NILP (font_names))
10722 {
10723 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
10724 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
10725 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
10726 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
10727 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
10728 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
10729 Qnil);
10730
10731 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
10732 Fcons (Fcons (key,
10733 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
10734 make_number (fontp->size)),
10735 Qnil)),
10736 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
10737 if (full_name)
10738 {
10739 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
10740 Qnil);
10741 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
10742 Fcons (Fcons (key,
10743 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
10744 make_number (fontp->size)),
10745 Qnil)),
10746 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
10747 }
10748 }
10749
10750 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
10751 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
10752 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
10753 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
10754 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
10755 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding_type
10756 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
10757 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
10758 fontp->encoding_type
10759 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
10760 /* 1-byte font */
10761 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10762 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10763 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
10764 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
10765 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
10766 /* 2-byte font */
10767 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
10768 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
10769 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10770 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10771 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
10772 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
10773 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
10774 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
10775 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10776 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10777 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
10778 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
10779 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
10780
10781 fontp->baseline_offset
10782 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
10783 ? (long) value : 0);
10784 fontp->relative_compose
10785 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
10786 ? (long) value : 0);
10787 fontp->default_ascent
10788 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
10789 ? (long) value : 0);
10790
10791 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
10792 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
10793 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
10794 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
10795 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
10796 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
10797 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10798 return fontp;
10799 }
10800 }
10801
10802
10803 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
10804 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
10805
10806 struct font_info *
10807 x_query_font (f, fontname)
10808 struct frame *f;
10809 register char *fontname;
10810 {
10811 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10812 int i;
10813
10814 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10815 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
10816 && (!xstricmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
10817 || !xstricmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
10818 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
10819 return NULL;
10820 }
10821
10822
10823 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
10824 `encoder' of the structure. */
10825
10826 void
10827 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
10828 struct font_info *fontp;
10829 {
10830 Lisp_Object list, elt;
10831
10832 elt = Qnil;
10833 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
10834 {
10835 elt = XCAR (list);
10836 if (CONSP (elt)
10837 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
10838 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
10839 >= 0)
10840 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
10841 >= 0)))
10842 break;
10843 }
10844
10845 if (! NILP (list))
10846 {
10847 struct ccl_program *ccl
10848 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
10849
10850 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
10851 xfree (ccl);
10852 else
10853 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
10854 }
10855 }
10856
10857
10858 /* Return a char-table whose elements are t if the font FONT_INFO
10859 contains a glyph for the corresponding character, and nil if
10860 not. */
10861
10862 Lisp_Object
10863 x_get_font_repertory (f, font_info)
10864 FRAME_PTR f;
10865 struct font_info *font_info;
10866 {
10867 XFontStruct *font = (XFontStruct *) font_info->font;
10868 Lisp_Object table;
10869 int min_byte1, max_byte1, min_byte2, max_byte2;
10870 int c;
10871 struct charset *charset = CHARSET_FROM_ID (font_info->charset);
10872 int offset = CHARSET_OFFSET (charset);
10873
10874 table = Fmake_char_table (Qnil, Qnil);
10875
10876 min_byte1 = font->min_byte1;
10877 max_byte1 = font->max_byte1;
10878 min_byte2 = font->min_char_or_byte2;
10879 max_byte2 = font->max_char_or_byte2;
10880 if (min_byte1 == 0 && max_byte1 == 0)
10881 {
10882 if (! font->per_char || font->all_chars_exist == True)
10883 {
10884 if (offset >= 0)
10885 char_table_set_range (table, offset + min_byte2,
10886 offset + max_byte2, Qt);
10887 else
10888 for (; min_byte2 <= max_byte2; min_byte2++)
10889 {
10890 c = DECODE_CHAR (charset, min_byte2);
10891 CHAR_TABLE_SET (table, c, Qt);
10892 }
10893 }
10894 else
10895 {
10896 XCharStruct *pcm = font->per_char;
10897 int from = -1;
10898 int i;
10899
10900 for (i = min_byte2; i <= max_byte2; i++, pcm++)
10901 {
10902 if (pcm->width == 0 && pcm->rbearing == pcm->lbearing)
10903 {
10904 if (from >= 0)
10905 {
10906 if (offset >= 0)
10907 char_table_set_range (table, offset + from,
10908 offset + i - 1, Qt);
10909 else
10910 for (; from < i; from++)
10911 {
10912 c = DECODE_CHAR (charset, from);
10913 CHAR_TABLE_SET (table, c, Qt);
10914 }
10915 from = -1;
10916 }
10917 }
10918 else if (from < 0)
10919 from = i;
10920 }
10921 if (from >= 0)
10922 {
10923 if (offset >= 0)
10924 char_table_set_range (table, offset + from, offset + i - 1,
10925 Qt);
10926 else
10927 for (; from < i; from++)
10928 {
10929 c = DECODE_CHAR (charset, from);
10930 CHAR_TABLE_SET (table, c, Qt);
10931 }
10932 }
10933 }
10934 }
10935 else
10936 {
10937 if (! font->per_char || font->all_chars_exist == True)
10938 {
10939 int i, j;
10940
10941 if (offset >= 0)
10942 for (i = min_byte1; i <= max_byte1; i++)
10943 char_table_set_range
10944 (table, offset + ((i << 8) | min_byte2),
10945 offset + ((i << 8) | max_byte2), Qt);
10946 else
10947 for (i = min_byte1; i <= max_byte1; i++)
10948 for (j = min_byte2; j <= max_byte2; j++)
10949 {
10950 unsigned code = (i << 8) | j;
10951 c = DECODE_CHAR (charset, code);
10952 CHAR_TABLE_SET (table, c, Qt);
10953 }
10954 }
10955 else
10956 {
10957 XCharStruct *pcm = font->per_char;
10958 int i;
10959
10960 for (i = min_byte1; i <= max_byte1; i++)
10961 {
10962 int from = -1;
10963 int j;
10964
10965 for (j = min_byte2; j <= max_byte2; j++, pcm++)
10966 {
10967 if (pcm->width == 0 && pcm->rbearing == pcm->lbearing)
10968 {
10969 if (from >= 0)
10970 {
10971 if (offset >= 0)
10972 char_table_set_range
10973 (table, offset + ((i << 8) | from),
10974 offset + ((i << 8) | (j - 1)), Qt);
10975 else
10976 {
10977 for (; from < j; from++)
10978 {
10979 unsigned code = (i << 8) | from;
10980 c = ENCODE_CHAR (charset, code);
10981 CHAR_TABLE_SET (table, c, Qt);
10982 }
10983 }
10984 from = -1;
10985 }
10986 }
10987 else if (from < 0)
10988 from = j;
10989 }
10990 if (from >= 0)
10991 {
10992 if (offset >= 0)
10993 char_table_set_range
10994 (table, offset + ((i << 8) | from),
10995 offset + ((i << 8) | (j - 1)), Qt);
10996 else
10997 {
10998 for (; from < j; from++)
10999 {
11000 unsigned code = (i << 8) | from;
11001 c = DECODE_CHAR (charset, code);
11002 CHAR_TABLE_SET (table, c, Qt);
11003 }
11004 }
11005 }
11006 }
11007 }
11008 }
11009
11010 return table;
11011 }
11012 \f
11013 /***********************************************************************
11014 Initialization
11015 ***********************************************************************/
11016
11017 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11018 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
11019 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
11020 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
11021
11022 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
11023 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
11024 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
11025
11026 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
11027 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
11028 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
11029 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
11030 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
11031 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
11032 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
11033 };
11034
11035 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
11036
11037 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
11038
11039 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11040
11041 static int x_initialized;
11042
11043 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
11044 static int x_session_initialized;
11045 #endif
11046
11047 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
11048 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
11049 the screen number from the server number. */
11050 static int
11051 same_x_server (name1, name2)
11052 const char *name1, *name2;
11053 {
11054 int seen_colon = 0;
11055 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
11056 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
11057 int length_until_period = 0;
11058
11059 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
11060 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
11061 length_until_period++;
11062
11063 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
11064 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
11065 name1 += 4;
11066 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
11067 name2 += 4;
11068 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
11069 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
11070 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
11071 name1 += system_name_length;
11072 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
11073 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
11074 name2 += system_name_length;
11075 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
11076 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
11077 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
11078 name1 += length_until_period;
11079 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
11080 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
11081 name2 += length_until_period;
11082
11083 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
11084 {
11085 if (*name1 == ':')
11086 seen_colon++;
11087 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
11088 return 1;
11089 }
11090 return (seen_colon
11091 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
11092 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
11093 }
11094 #endif
11095
11096 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
11097 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
11098 to 5. */
11099 static void
11100 get_bits_and_offset (mask, bits, offset)
11101 unsigned long mask;
11102 int *bits;
11103 int *offset;
11104 {
11105 int nr = 0;
11106 int off = 0;
11107
11108 while (!(mask & 1))
11109 {
11110 off++;
11111 mask >>= 1;
11112 }
11113
11114 while (mask & 1)
11115 {
11116 nr++;
11117 mask >>= 1;
11118 }
11119
11120 *offset = off;
11121 *bits = nr;
11122 }
11123
11124 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
11125 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
11126
11127 int
11128 x_display_ok (display)
11129 const char *display;
11130 {
11131 int dpy_ok = 1;
11132 Display *dpy;
11133
11134 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
11135 if (dpy)
11136 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
11137 else
11138 dpy_ok = 0;
11139 return dpy_ok;
11140 }
11141
11142 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
11143 the structure that describes the open display.
11144 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
11145
11146 struct x_display_info *
11147 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
11148 Lisp_Object display_name;
11149 char *xrm_option;
11150 char *resource_name;
11151 {
11152 int connection;
11153 Display *dpy;
11154 struct terminal *terminal;
11155 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
11156 XrmDatabase xrdb;
11157
11158 BLOCK_INPUT;
11159
11160 if (!x_initialized)
11161 {
11162 x_initialize ();
11163 ++x_initialized;
11164 }
11165
11166 if (! x_display_ok (SDATA (display_name)))
11167 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SDATA (display_name));
11168
11169 #ifdef USE_GTK
11170 {
11171 #define NUM_ARGV 10
11172 int argc;
11173 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
11174 char **argv2 = argv;
11175 GdkAtom atom;
11176
11177 #ifndef HAVE_GTK_MULTIDISPLAY
11178 if (!EQ (Vinitial_window_system, intern ("x")))
11179 error ("Sorry, you cannot connect to X servers with the GTK toolkit");
11180 #endif
11181
11182 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
11183 {
11184 #ifdef HAVE_GTK_MULTIDISPLAY
11185 /* Opening another display. If xg_display_open returns less
11186 than zero, we are probably on GTK 2.0, which can only handle
11187 one display. GTK 2.2 or later can handle more than one. */
11188 if (xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy) < 0)
11189 #endif
11190 error ("Sorry, this version of GTK can only handle one display");
11191 }
11192 else
11193 {
11194 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
11195 argv[argc] = 0;
11196
11197 argc = 0;
11198 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
11199
11200 if (! NILP (display_name))
11201 {
11202 argv[argc++] = "--display";
11203 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
11204 }
11205
11206 argv[argc++] = "--name";
11207 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
11208
11209 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
11210
11211 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
11212
11213 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
11214 fixup_locale ();
11215 xg_initialize ();
11216
11217 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
11218
11219 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
11220 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
11221
11222 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
11223 {
11224 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
11225 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
11226
11227 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
11228 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
11229
11230 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
11231 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
11232 }
11233
11234 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
11235 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
11236 }
11237 }
11238 #else /* not USE_GTK */
11239 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11240 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
11241 errors with X11R5:
11242 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
11243 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
11244 So let's not use it until R6. */
11245 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
11246 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
11247 #endif
11248
11249 {
11250 int argc = 0;
11251 char *argv[3];
11252
11253 argv[0] = "";
11254 argc = 1;
11255 if (xrm_option)
11256 {
11257 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
11258 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
11259 }
11260 turn_on_atimers (0);
11261 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
11262 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
11263 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
11264 &argc, argv);
11265 turn_on_atimers (1);
11266
11267 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
11268 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
11269 fixup_locale ();
11270 #endif
11271 }
11272
11273 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11274 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
11275 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
11276 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11277 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
11278
11279 /* Detect failure. */
11280 if (dpy == 0)
11281 {
11282 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11283 return 0;
11284 }
11285
11286 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
11287
11288 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
11289 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
11290
11291 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
11292
11293 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
11294 {
11295 struct x_display_info *share;
11296 Lisp_Object tail;
11297
11298 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
11299 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
11300 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
11301 SDATA (display_name)))
11302 break;
11303 if (share)
11304 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
11305 else
11306 {
11307 terminal->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
11308 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
11309 terminal->kboard->Vwindow_system = intern ("x");
11310 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
11311 {
11312 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
11313 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11314 terminal->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
11315 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
11316 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string);
11317 BLOCK_INPUT;
11318 }
11319
11320 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
11321 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
11322 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
11323 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
11324 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
11325 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
11326 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
11327 }
11328 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
11329 }
11330 #endif
11331
11332 /* Put this display on the chain. */
11333 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
11334 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
11335
11336 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
11337 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
11338 x_display_name_list);
11339 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
11340
11341 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
11342
11343 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
11344 terminal->name = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
11345 strncpy (terminal->name, SDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
11346 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
11347
11348 #if 0
11349 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
11350 #endif /* ! 0 */
11351
11352 dpyinfo->x_id_name
11353 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
11354 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
11355 + 2);
11356 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
11357 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
11358
11359 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
11360 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
11361
11362 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
11363 #ifdef USE_GTK
11364 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
11365 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
11366 #endif /* USE_GTK */
11367
11368 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
11369 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
11370
11371 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
11372 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
11373 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
11374 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
11375 #else
11376 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
11377 #endif
11378 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
11379 all versions. */
11380 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
11381
11382 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
11383 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
11384 select_visual (dpyinfo);
11385 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
11386 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
11387 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
11388 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
11389 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
11390 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
11391 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
11392 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
11393 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
11394 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
11395 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
11396 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
11397 dpyinfo->font = XLoadQueryFont (dpyinfo->display, "fixed");
11398 if (! dpyinfo->font)
11399 dpyinfo->font = XLoadQueryFont (dpyinfo->display, "*");
11400 if (! dpyinfo->font)
11401 abort ();
11402 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
11403 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
11404 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
11405 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
11406 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
11407 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
11408 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
11409 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
11410 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
11411 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
11412 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
11413 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
11414 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
11415 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
11416 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
11417 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
11418 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
11419 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
11420 dpyinfo->terminal->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
11421 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
11422
11423 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
11424 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
11425 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
11426
11427 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
11428 {
11429 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
11430 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
11431 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
11432 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
11433 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
11434 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
11435 }
11436
11437 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
11438 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
11439 {
11440 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
11441 {
11442 Lisp_Object value;
11443 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
11444 build_string ("privateColormap"),
11445 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
11446 Qnil, Qnil);
11447 if (STRINGP (value)
11448 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
11449 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
11450 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
11451 }
11452 }
11453 else
11454 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
11455 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
11456
11457 {
11458 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
11459 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
11460 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
11461 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
11462 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
11463 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
11464 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
11465 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
11466 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
11467 }
11468
11469 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
11470 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
11471 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
11472 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
11473 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
11474 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
11475 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
11476 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
11477 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
11478 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
11479 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
11480 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
11481 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
11482 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
11483 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader
11484 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False);
11485 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
11486 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
11487 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
11488 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
11489 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
11490 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
11491 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
11492 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
11493 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
11494 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
11495 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
11496 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
11497 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
11498 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
11499 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
11500 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
11501 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
11502 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
11503 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
11504 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
11505 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
11506 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
11507 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
11508 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
11509 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
11510 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
11511 /* For properties of font. */
11512 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
11513 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
11514 dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
11515 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "AVERAGE_WIDTH", False);
11516 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
11517 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
11518 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
11519 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
11520 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
11521 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
11522
11523 /* Ghostscript support. */
11524 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
11525 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
11526
11527 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
11528 False);
11529
11530 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_XEMBED",
11531 False);
11532
11533 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
11534
11535 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
11536 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
11537 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
11538 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
11539
11540 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
11541 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
11542 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
11543
11544 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
11545 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
11546
11547 {
11548 char null_bits[1];
11549
11550 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
11551
11552 dpyinfo->null_pixel
11553 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
11554 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
11555 1);
11556 }
11557
11558 {
11559 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
11560 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
11561 dpyinfo->gray
11562 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
11563 gray_bitmap_bits,
11564 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
11565 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
11566 }
11567
11568 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
11569 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
11570 #endif
11571
11572 #ifdef subprocesses
11573 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
11574 if (connection != 0)
11575 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
11576 #endif
11577
11578 #ifdef F_SETOWN
11579 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
11580 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
11581
11582 #ifdef SIGIO
11583 if (interrupt_input)
11584 init_sigio (connection);
11585 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
11586
11587 #ifdef USE_LUCID
11588 {
11589 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
11590 XrmValue d, fr, to;
11591 Font font;
11592
11593 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
11594 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
11595 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
11596 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
11597 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
11598 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
11599 x_catch_errors (dpy);
11600 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
11601 abort ();
11602 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
11603 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
11604 x_uncatch_errors ();
11605 }
11606 #endif
11607
11608 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
11609 for debugging X code. */
11610 {
11611 Lisp_Object value;
11612 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
11613 build_string ("synchronous"),
11614 build_string ("Synchronous"),
11615 Qnil, Qnil);
11616 if (STRINGP (value)
11617 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
11618 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
11619 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
11620 }
11621
11622 {
11623 Lisp_Object value;
11624 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
11625 build_string ("useXIM"),
11626 build_string ("UseXIM"),
11627 Qnil, Qnil);
11628 #ifdef USE_XIM
11629 if (STRINGP (value)
11630 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "false")
11631 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "off")))
11632 use_xim = 0;
11633 #else
11634 if (STRINGP (value)
11635 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
11636 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
11637 use_xim = 1;
11638 #endif
11639 }
11640
11641 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
11642 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
11643 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
11644 tty. */
11645 if (terminal->id == 1)
11646 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
11647 #endif
11648
11649 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11650
11651 return dpyinfo;
11652 }
11653 \f
11654 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
11655 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
11656
11657 void
11658 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
11659 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
11660 {
11661 int i;
11662 struct terminal *t;
11663
11664 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
11665 X display. */
11666 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
11667 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
11668 {
11669 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
11670 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
11671 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
11672 x_session_close();
11673 #endif
11674 delete_terminal (t);
11675 break;
11676 }
11677
11678 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
11679
11680 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
11681 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
11682 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
11683 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
11684 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
11685 else
11686 {
11687 Lisp_Object tail;
11688
11689 tail = x_display_name_list;
11690 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
11691 {
11692 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
11693 {
11694 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
11695 break;
11696 }
11697 tail = XCDR (tail);
11698 }
11699 }
11700
11701 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
11702 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
11703
11704 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
11705 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
11706 else
11707 {
11708 struct x_display_info *tail;
11709
11710 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
11711 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
11712 tail->next = tail->next->next;
11713 }
11714
11715 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
11716 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
11717 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
11718 #endif
11719 #endif
11720 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
11721 if (dpyinfo->xim)
11722 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
11723 #endif
11724
11725 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
11726 if (! enable_font_backend)
11727 {
11728 #endif
11729 /* Free the font names in the font table. */
11730 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
11731 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
11732 {
11733 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name != dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name)
11734 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name);
11735 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name);
11736 }
11737
11738 if (dpyinfo->font_table)
11739 {
11740 if (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder)
11741 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder);
11742 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
11743 }
11744 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
11745 }
11746 #endif
11747
11748 if (dpyinfo->x_id_name)
11749 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
11750 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
11751 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
11752 xfree (dpyinfo);
11753 }
11754
11755 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11756
11757 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
11758 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
11759 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
11760 that slows us down. */
11761
11762 static void
11763 x_process_timeouts (timer)
11764 struct atimer *timer;
11765 {
11766 BLOCK_INPUT;
11767 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
11768 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
11769 {
11770 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
11771 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
11772 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
11773 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
11774 }
11775 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11776 }
11777
11778 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
11779 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
11780 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
11781 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
11782 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
11783 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
11784 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
11785
11786 void
11787 x_activate_timeout_atimer ()
11788 {
11789 BLOCK_INPUT;
11790 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
11791 {
11792 EMACS_TIME interval;
11793
11794 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
11795 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
11796 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
11797 }
11798 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11799 }
11800
11801 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11802
11803 \f
11804 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
11805
11806 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
11807
11808 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
11809 {
11810 x_frame_parm_handlers,
11811 x_produce_glyphs,
11812 x_write_glyphs,
11813 x_insert_glyphs,
11814 x_clear_end_of_line,
11815 x_scroll_run,
11816 x_after_update_window_line,
11817 x_update_window_begin,
11818 x_update_window_end,
11819 x_cursor_to,
11820 x_flush,
11821 #ifdef XFlush
11822 x_flush,
11823 #else
11824 0, /* flush_display_optional */
11825 #endif
11826 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
11827 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
11828 x_fix_overlapping_area,
11829 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
11830 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
11831 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
11832 x_per_char_metric,
11833 x_encode_char,
11834 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
11835 x_draw_glyph_string,
11836 x_define_frame_cursor,
11837 x_clear_frame_area,
11838 x_draw_window_cursor,
11839 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
11840 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
11841 };
11842
11843
11844 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
11845 void
11846 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
11847 {
11848 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
11849 int i;
11850
11851 /* Protect against recursive calls. Fdelete_frame in
11852 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
11853 if (!terminal->name)
11854 return;
11855
11856 BLOCK_INPUT;
11857 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
11858 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
11859 if (dpyinfo->display)
11860 {
11861 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
11862 if (enable_font_backend)
11863 XFreeFont (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->font);
11864 else
11865 #endif
11866 /* Free the fonts in the font table. */
11867 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
11868 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
11869 {
11870 XFreeFont (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->font_table[i].font);
11871 }
11872
11873 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
11874 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
11875
11876 #ifdef USE_GTK
11877 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
11878 #else
11879 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11880 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
11881 #else
11882 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
11883 #endif
11884 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
11885 }
11886
11887 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
11888 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11889 }
11890
11891 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
11892 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
11893
11894 static struct terminal *
11895 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
11896 {
11897 struct terminal *terminal;
11898
11899 terminal = create_terminal ();
11900
11901 terminal->type = output_x_window;
11902 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
11903 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
11904
11905 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
11906
11907 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
11908 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
11909 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
11910 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
11911 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
11912 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
11913 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
11914 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
11915 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
11916 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
11917 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
11918 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
11919 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
11920 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
11921 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
11922 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
11923 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
11924 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
11925 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
11926
11927 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
11928 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
11929
11930 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
11931 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
11932 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
11933 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
11934 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
11935 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
11936 off the bottom. */
11937
11938 return terminal;
11939 }
11940
11941 void
11942 x_initialize ()
11943 {
11944 baud_rate = 19200;
11945
11946 x_noop_count = 0;
11947 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
11948 any_help_event_p = 0;
11949 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
11950 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
11951 x_session_initialized = 0;
11952 #endif
11953
11954 #ifdef USE_GTK
11955 current_count = -1;
11956 #endif
11957
11958 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
11959 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
11960
11961 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11962 XtToolkitInitialize ();
11963
11964 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
11965
11966 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
11967 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
11968 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
11969 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
11970 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
11971 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
11972 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
11973
11974 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
11975 #endif
11976
11977 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11978 #ifndef USE_GTK
11979 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
11980 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
11981 #endif
11982 #endif
11983
11984 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
11985 original error handler. */
11986 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
11987 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
11988
11989 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
11990 #if 0 /* Don't. We may want to open tty frames later. */
11991 #ifdef SIGWINCH
11992 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
11993 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
11994 #endif
11995
11996 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
11997 }
11998
11999
12000 void
12001 syms_of_xterm ()
12002 {
12003 x_error_message = NULL;
12004
12005 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
12006 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
12007
12008 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
12009 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
12010
12011 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
12012 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
12013
12014 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
12015 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
12016
12017 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
12018 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
12019
12020 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
12021 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
12022 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
12023 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
12024 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
12025 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
12026 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
12027
12028 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
12029 &x_underline_at_descent_line,
12030 doc: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
12031 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
12032 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
12033 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
12034 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
12035
12036 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
12037 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
12038 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
12039 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
12040 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
12041 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
12042 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
12043 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
12044 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
12045
12046 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
12047 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
12048 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
12049 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
12050 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
12051 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
12052 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
12053 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
12054 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
12055 #elif USE_GTK
12056 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("gtk");
12057 #else
12058 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
12059 #endif
12060 #else
12061 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
12062 #endif
12063
12064 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
12065 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
12066
12067 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
12068 Qalt = intern ("alt");
12069 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
12070 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
12071 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
12072 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
12073 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
12074 Qsuper = intern ("super");
12075 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
12076
12077 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
12078 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
12079 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
12080 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
12081 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
12082 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
12083
12084 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
12085 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
12086 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
12087 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
12088 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
12089 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
12090
12091 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
12092 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
12093 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
12094 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
12095 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
12096 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
12097
12098 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
12099 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
12100 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
12101 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
12102 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
12103 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
12104
12105 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
12106 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
12107 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
12108 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
12109 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
12110 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
12111 }
12112
12113 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
12114
12115 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
12116 (do not change this comment) */